Add a changelog entry for merging package name syntax requirements
[debian-policy.git] / policy.sgml
blob91ec2e68dd5e692f152676812e2ae2c999d1867f
1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 ]>
6 <debiandoc>
8 <book>
9 <titlepag>
10 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
11 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
12 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
14 <abstract>
15 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
16 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
17 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
18 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
19 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
20 </abstract>
22 <copyright>
23 <copyrightsummary>
24 Copyright &copy; 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
25 and Christian Schwarz.
26 </copyrightsummary>
27 <p>
28 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
29 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
30 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
31 work exists.
32 </p>
34 <p>
35 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
36 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
37 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
38 2, or (at your option) any later version.
39 </p>
41 <p>
42 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
43 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
44 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
45 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
46 details.
47 </p>
49 <p>
50 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
51 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian GNU/Linux
52 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
53 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
54 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
55 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
56 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
57 </p>
58 </copyright>
59 </titlepag>
61 <toc detail="sect1">
63 <chapt id="scope">
64 <heading>About this manual</heading>
65 <sect>
66 <heading>Scope</heading>
67 <p>
68 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
69 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
70 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
71 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
72 each package must satisfy to be included in the
73 distribution.
74 </p>
76 <p>
77 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
78 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
79 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
80 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
81 attempts to define the interface to the package management
82 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
83 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
84 material meet one of the following requirements:
85 <taglist compact="compact">
86 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
87 <item>
88 The material presented represents an interface to
89 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
90 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
91 therefore should not be changed without peer
92 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
93 interfaces not changing, and the package
94 management software authors need to ensure
95 compatibility with these interface
96 definitions. (Control file and changelog file
97 formats are examples.)
98 </item>
99 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
100 <item>
101 If there are a number of technically viable choices
102 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
103 these options for inter-operability. The version
104 number format is one example.
105 </item>
106 </taglist>
107 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
108 selected conventions often become parts of standard
109 interfaces.
110 </footnote>
111 </p>
114 The footnotes present in this manual are
115 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
116 </p>
119 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
120 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
121 </p>
124 In the normative part of this manual,
125 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
126 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
127 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
128 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
129 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
130 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
131 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
132 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
133 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
134 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
135 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
136 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
137 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
138 </p>
141 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
142 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
143 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
144 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
145 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
146 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
147 items).
148 <footnote>
149 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
150 used in a different way in this document.
151 </footnote>
152 </p>
155 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
156 useful even when building a package which is to be
157 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
158 only.
159 </p>
160 </sect>
162 <sect>
163 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
166 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
167 <package><url name="debian-policy"
168 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
169 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
170 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
171 </p>
174 The current version of this document is also available from
175 the Debian web mirrors at
176 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
177 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
179 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
180 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
181 Also available from the same directory are several other
182 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
183 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
184 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
185 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
186 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
187 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
188 </p>
191 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
192 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
193 changes between versions of this document.
194 </p>
195 </sect>
197 <sect id="authors">
198 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
201 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
202 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
203 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
204 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
205 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
206 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
207 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
208 </p>
211 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
212 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
213 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
214 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
215 consensus is established.
216 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
217 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
218 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
220 <enumlist>
221 <item>Julian Gilbey</item>
222 <item>Branden Robinson</item>
223 <item>Josip Rodin</item>
224 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
225 </enumlist>
226 </p>
229 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
230 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
231 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
232 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
233 the Debian Policy List,
234 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
235 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
236 </p>
239 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
240 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
241 </p>
242 </sect>
244 <sect id="related">
245 <heading>Related documents</heading>
248 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
249 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
250 procedures.
251 </p>
254 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
255 <list compact="compact">
256 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
257 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
258 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
259 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
260 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
261 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
262 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
263 </list>
264 </p>
267 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
268 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
269 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
270 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
271 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
272 </p>
275 The Developer's Reference is available in the
276 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
277 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
278 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
279 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
280 </p>
281 </sect>
283 <sect id="definitions">
284 <heading>Definitions</heading>
287 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
288 <taglist>
289 <tag>ASCII</tag>
290 <item>
291 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
292 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
293 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
294 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
295 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
296 </item>
297 <tag>UTF-8</tag>
298 <item>
299 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
300 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
301 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
302 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
303 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
304 also valid UTF-8.
305 </item>
306 </taglist>
307 </p>
308 </sect>
309 </chapt>
312 <chapt id="archive">
313 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
316 The Debian GNU/Linux system is maintained and distributed as a
317 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
318 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
319 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
320 the handling of them.
321 </p>
324 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
325 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
326 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
327 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
328 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
329 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
330 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
331 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
332 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
333 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
334 </p>
337 The aims of this are:
339 <list compact="compact">
340 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
341 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
342 and</item>
343 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
344 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
345 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
346 </list>
347 </p>
350 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian GNU/Linux
351 distribution</em>.
352 </p>
355 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
356 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
357 distribution, although we support their use and provide
358 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
359 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
360 packages as well.
361 </p>
363 <sect id="dfsg">
364 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
366 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
367 definition of "free software". These are:
368 <taglist>
369 <tag>Free Redistribution
370 </tag>
371 <item>
372 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
373 party from selling or giving away the software as a
374 component of an aggregate software distribution
375 containing programs from several different
376 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
377 other fee for such sale.
378 </item>
379 <tag>Source Code
380 </tag>
381 <item>
382 The program must include source code, and must allow
383 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
384 </item>
385 <tag>Derived Works
386 </tag>
387 <item>
388 The license must allow modifications and derived
389 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
390 same terms as the license of the original software.
391 </item>
392 <tag>Integrity of The Author's Source Code
393 </tag>
394 <item>
395 The license may restrict source-code from being
396 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
397 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
398 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
399 program at build time. The license must explicitly
400 permit distribution of software built from modified
401 source code. The license may require derived works to
402 carry a different name or version number from the
403 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
404 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
405 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
406 </item>
407 <tag>No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
408 </tag>
409 <item>
410 The license must not discriminate against any person
411 or group of persons.
412 </item>
413 <tag>No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
414 </tag>
415 <item>
416 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
417 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
418 example, it may not restrict the program from being
419 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
420 research.
421 </item>
422 <tag>Distribution of License
423 </tag>
424 <item>
425 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
426 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
427 for execution of an additional license by those
428 parties.
429 </item>
430 <tag>License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
431 </tag>
432 <item>
433 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
434 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
435 program is extracted from Debian and used or
436 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
437 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
438 the program is redistributed must have the same
439 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
440 the Debian system.
441 </item>
442 <tag>License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
443 </tag>
444 <item>
445 The license must not place restrictions on other
446 software that is distributed along with the licensed
447 software. For example, the license must not insist
448 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
449 must be free software.
450 </item>
451 <tag>Example Licenses
452 </tag>
453 <item>
454 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
455 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
456 </item>
457 </taglist>
458 </p>
459 </sect>
461 <sect id="sections">
462 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
464 <sect1 id="main">
465 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
468 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
469 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
470 </p>
473 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
474 <list compact="compact">
475 <item>
476 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
477 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
478 not declare a "Depends", "Recommends", or
479 "Build-Depends" relationship on a non-<em>main</em>
480 package),
481 </item>
482 <item>
483 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
485 </item>
486 <item>
487 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
488 manual.
489 </item>
490 </list>
491 </p>
493 </sect1>
495 <sect1 id="contrib">
496 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
499 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
500 </p>
503 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
504 <list compact="compact">
505 <item>
506 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
508 </item>
509 <item>
510 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
511 manual.
512 </item>
513 </list>
514 </p>
518 Examples of packages which would be included in
519 <em>contrib</em> are:
520 <list compact="compact">
521 <item>
522 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
523 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
524 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
526 </item>
527 <item>
528 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
529 non-free programs.
530 </item>
531 </list>
532 </p>
533 </sect1>
535 <sect1 id="non-free">
536 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
539 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
540 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
541 or other legal issues that make their distribution
542 problematic.
543 </p>
546 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
547 <list compact="compact">
548 <item>
549 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
551 </item>
552 <item>
553 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
554 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
555 <footnote>
556 It is possible that there are policy
557 requirements which the package is unable to
558 meet, for example, if the source is
559 unavailable. These situations will need to be
560 handled on a case-by-case basis.
561 </footnote>
562 </item>
563 </list>
564 </p>
565 </sect1>
567 </sect>
569 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
570 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
573 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of
574 its copyright and distribution license in the file
575 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
576 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
577 </p>
580 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
581 anywhere in our archives if
582 <list compact="compact">
583 <item>
584 their use or distribution would break a law,
585 </item>
586 <item>
587 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
588 use,
589 </item>
590 <item>
591 we would have to sign a license for them, or
592 </item>
593 <item>
594 their distribution would conflict with other project
595 policies.
596 </item>
597 </list>
598 </p>
601 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
602 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
603 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
604 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
605 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
606 </p>
609 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
610 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
611 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
612 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
613 at all.
614 </p>
617 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
618 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
619 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
620 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
621 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
622 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
623 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
624 permitted then nothing is permitted.
625 </p>
628 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
629 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
630 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
631 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
632 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
633 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
634 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
635 explained below.
636 </p>
639 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
640 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
641 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
642 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
643 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
644 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
645 </p>
646 </sect>
648 <sect id="subsections">
649 <heading>Sections</heading>
652 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
653 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
654 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
655 </p>
658 The archive area and section for each package should be
659 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
660 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
661 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
662 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
663 of the form:
664 <list compact="compact">
665 <item>
666 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
667 <em>main</em> archive area,
668 </item>
669 <item>
670 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
671 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
672 archive areas.
673 </item>
674 </list>
675 </p>
678 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
679 list of sections. At present, they are:
680 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
681 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
682 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
683 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
684 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
685 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
686 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
687 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
688 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
689 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
690 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
691 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
692 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
693 <em>zope</em>.
694 </p>
695 </sect>
697 <sect id="priorities">
698 <heading>Priorities</heading>
701 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
702 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
703 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
704 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
705 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
706 </p>
709 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
710 Debian package management tools.
711 <taglist>
712 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
713 <item>
714 Packages which are necessary for the proper
715 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
716 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
717 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
718 system to become totally broken and you may not even
719 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
720 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
721 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
722 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
723 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
724 </item>
725 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
726 <item>
727 Important programs, including those which one would
728 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
729 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
730 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
731 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
732 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
733 This is an important criterion because we are
734 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
735 Unix.
736 </footnote>
737 Other packages without which the system will not run
738 well or be usable must also have priority
739 <tt>important</tt>. This does
740 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
741 or any other large applications. The
742 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
743 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
744 </item>
745 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
746 <item>
747 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
748 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
749 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
750 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
751 </item>
752 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
753 <item>
754 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
755 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
756 all the software that you might reasonably want to
757 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
758 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
759 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
760 distribution, and many applications. Note that
761 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
762 </item>
763 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
764 <item>
765 This contains all packages that conflict with others
766 with required, important, standard or optional
767 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
768 already know what they are or have specialized
769 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
770 debugging symbols).
771 </item>
772 </taglist>
773 </p>
776 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
777 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
778 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
779 to be adjusted.
780 </p>
781 </sect>
783 </chapt>
786 <chapt id="binary">
787 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
790 The Debian GNU/Linux distribution is based on the Debian
791 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
792 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
793 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
794 </p>
796 <sect>
797 <heading>The package name</heading>
800 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
801 archive.
802 </p>
805 The package name is included in the control field
806 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
807 in <ref id="f-Package">.
808 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
809 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
810 </p>
811 </sect>
813 <sect id="versions">
814 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
817 Every package has a version number recorded in its
818 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
819 <ref id="f-Version">.
820 </p>
823 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
824 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
825 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
826 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
827 the one installed on the system. The version number format
828 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
829 concerned) at the beginning.
830 </p>
833 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
834 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
835 <tt>Version</tt> field.
836 </p>
838 <sect1>
839 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
842 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
843 numbers as the upstream sources.
844 </p>
847 However, in some cases where the upstream version number is
848 based on a date (e.g., a development "snapshot" release) the
849 package management system cannot handle these version
850 numbers without epochs. For example, dpkg will consider
851 "96May01" to be greater than "96Dec24".
852 </p>
855 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
856 version, the date based portion of the version number
857 should be changed to the following format in such cases:
858 "19960501", "19961224". It is up to the maintainer whether
859 they want to bother the upstream maintainer to change
860 the version numbers upstream, too.
861 </p>
864 Note that other version formats based on dates which are
865 parsed correctly by the package management system should
866 <em>not</em> be changed.
867 </p>
870 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been
871 written especially for Debian) whose version numbers include
872 dates should always use the "YYYYMMDD" format.
873 </p>
874 </sect1>
876 </sect>
878 <sect>
879 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
882 Every package must have a Debian maintainer (the
883 maintainer may be one person or a group of people
884 reachable from a common email address, such as a mailing
885 list). The maintainer is responsible for ensuring that
886 the package is placed in the appropriate distributions.
887 </p>
890 The maintainer must be specified in the
891 <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field with their correct name
892 and a working email address. If one person maintains
893 several packages, they should try to avoid having
894 different forms of their name and email address in
895 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
896 </p>
899 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
900 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
901 </p>
904 If the maintainer of a package quits from the Debian
905 project, "Debian QA Group"
906 <email>packages@qa.debian.org</email> takes over the
907 maintainer-ship of the package until someone else
908 volunteers for that task. These packages are called
909 <em>orphaned packages</em>.<footnote>
910 The detailed procedure for doing this gracefully can
911 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference,
912 see <ref id="related">.
913 </footnote>
914 </p>
915 </sect>
917 <sect id="descriptions">
918 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
921 Every Debian package must have an extended description
922 stored in the appropriate field of the control record.
923 The technical information about the format of the
924 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
925 </p>
928 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
929 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
930 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
931 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
932 from the program's documentation.
933 </p>
936 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
937 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
938 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
939 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
940 extended description.
941 </p>
944 The description should also give information about the
945 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
946 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
947 conflicts have been declared.
948 </p>
951 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
952 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
953 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
954 statements and other administrivia should not be included
955 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
956 </p>
958 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
961 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
962 under 80 characters.
963 </p>
966 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
967 display software knows how to display this already, and you
968 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
969 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
970 informative as you can.
971 </p>
973 </sect1>
975 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
978 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
979 extended description. This will not work correctly when
980 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
981 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
982 available.
983 </p>
986 The extended description should describe what the package
987 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
988 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
989 </p>
992 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
993 people who have no idea about any of the things the
994 package deals with.<footnote>
995 The blurb that comes with a program in its
996 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
997 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
998 usually aimed at people who are already in the
999 community where the package is used.
1000 </footnote>
1001 </p>
1003 </sect1>
1005 </sect>
1007 <sect>
1008 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1011 Every package must specify the dependency information
1012 about other packages that are required for the first to
1013 work correctly.
1014 </p>
1017 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1018 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1019 binary in a package.
1020 </p>
1023 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1024 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1025 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1026 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1028 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1029 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1030 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1031 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1032 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1033 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1034 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1035 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1036 exists.
1037 </p>
1039 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1040 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1041 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1042 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1043 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1044 than good.
1045 </p>
1046 </footnote>
1047 </p>
1050 Sometimes, a package requires another package to be installed
1051 <em>and</em> configured before it can be installed. In this
1052 case, you must specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for
1053 the package.
1054 </p>
1057 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1058 package before this has been discussed on the
1059 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1060 doing that has been reached.
1061 </p>
1064 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1065 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1066 </p>
1067 </sect>
1069 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1070 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1073 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1074 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1075 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1076 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1077 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1078 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1079 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1080 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1081 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1082 specify all possible packages individually.
1083 </p>
1086 All packages should use virtual package names where
1087 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1088 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1089 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1090 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1091 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1092 </p>
1095 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1096 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1097 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1098 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1099 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1100 </p>
1103 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1104 to the list.
1105 </p>
1107 </sect>
1109 <sect>
1110 <heading>Base system</heading>
1113 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1114 GNU/Linux system that is installed before everything else
1115 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1116 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1117 usage very small.
1118 </p>
1121 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1122 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1123 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1124 </p>
1125 </sect>
1127 <sect>
1128 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1131 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1132 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1133 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1134 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1135 <tt>Essential</tt> control file field. The format of the
1136 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1137 id="f-Essential">.
1138 </p>
1141 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1142 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1143 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1144 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1145 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1146 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1147 remove it when it has been superseded.
1148 </p>
1151 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1152 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1153 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1154 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1155 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1156 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1157 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1158 appropriate.
1159 </p>
1162 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1163 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1164 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1165 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1166 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1167 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1168 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1169 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1170 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1171 perpetuity.
1172 </p>
1175 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1176 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1177 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1178 reached.
1179 </p>
1180 </sect>
1182 <sect id="maintscripts">
1183 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1186 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1187 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1188 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1189 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1190 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1191 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1192 </p>
1195 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1196 script must be checked and the installation must not
1197 continue after an error.
1198 </p>
1201 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1202 maintainer scripts, too.
1203 </p>
1206 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file
1207 belonging to another package without consulting the
1208 maintainer of that package first.
1209 </p>
1212 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1213 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1214 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1215 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1216 is not used, then each package must use
1217 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1218 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1219 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1220 that previously did not use
1221 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1222 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1223 avoided.)
1224 </p>
1226 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1227 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1229 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1230 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1231 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1232 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1233 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1234 </p>
1237 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1238 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1239 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1240 </p>
1243 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1244 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1245 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1246 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1247 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1248 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1249 </p>
1252 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1253 Specification may contain an additional
1254 <prgn>config</prgn> script and a <tt>templates</tt>
1255 file in their control archive<footnote>
1256 The control.tar.gz inside the .deb.
1257 See <manref name="deb" section="5">.
1258 </footnote>.
1259 The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before the
1260 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script, and before the package is unpacked
1261 or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied.
1262 Therefore it must work using only the tools present in
1263 <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1264 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1265 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1266 Specification will also be installed, and any
1267 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1268 before preconfiguration begins.
1269 </footnote>
1270 </p>
1273 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1274 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1275 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1276 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1277 </p>
1280 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1281 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1282 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1283 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1284 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1285 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1286 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1287 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1288 information.
1289 </p>
1292 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1293 questions again, unless the user has used
1294 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1295 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1296 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1297 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1298 documented.
1299 </p>
1302 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1303 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1304 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1305 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1306 messages"), it should display this in the
1307 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1308 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1309 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1310 important (they belong in
1311 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1312 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1313 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1314 can see them).
1315 </p>
1318 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1319 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1320 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1321 should be protected with a conditional so that
1322 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1323 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1324 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1325 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1326 </p>
1327 </sect1>
1329 </sect>
1331 </chapt>
1334 <chapt id="source">
1335 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1337 <sect id="standardsversion">
1338 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1341 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1342 of this policy document with which your package complied
1343 when it was last updated.
1344 </p>
1347 This information may be used to file bug reports
1348 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1349 </p>
1352 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1353 control field.
1354 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1355 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1356 </p>
1359 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1360 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1361 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1362 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1363 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1364 release it.<footnote>
1365 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1366 information about policy which has changed between
1367 different versions of this document.
1368 </footnote>
1369 </p>
1371 </sect>
1373 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1374 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1377 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1378 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1379 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1380 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1381 specified as a build-time dependency.
1382 </p>
1385 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1386 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1387 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1388 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1389 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1390 an informational list can be found in
1391 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1392 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1393 package).<footnote>
1394 Rationale:
1395 <list compact="compact">
1396 <item>
1397 This allows maintaining the list separately
1398 from the policy documents (the list does not
1399 need the kind of control that the policy
1400 documents do).
1401 </item>
1402 <item>
1403 Having a separate package allows one to install
1404 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1405 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1406 require installation of the build-essential
1407 packages using the depends relation.
1408 </item>
1409 <item>
1410 The separate package allows bug reports against
1411 the list to be categorized separately from
1412 the policy management process in the BTS.
1413 </item>
1414 </list>
1415 </footnote>
1416 </p>
1419 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1420 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1421 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1422 required merely because some other package in the list of
1423 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1424 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1425 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1426 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1427 others need is their business. For example, if you
1428 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1429 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1430 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1431 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1432 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1433 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1434 dependencies are satisfied.
1435 </footnote>
1436 </p>
1439 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1440 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1441 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1442 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1443 build-time relationships (including any implied
1444 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1445 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1446 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1447 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1448 are properly satisfied.
1449 </p>
1452 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1453 </p>
1454 </sect>
1456 <sect>
1457 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1460 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1461 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1462 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1463 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1464 package.
1465 </p>
1468 If you need to configure the package differently for
1469 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1470 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1471 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1472 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1473 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1474 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1475 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1476 </p>
1479 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1480 detects the correct architecture specification string
1481 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1482 </p>
1485 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1486 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1487 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1488 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1489 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1490 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1491 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1492 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1493 changes you made.
1494 </p>
1496 </sect>
1498 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1499 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1502 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1503 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1504 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1506 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1507 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1508 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1509 </p>
1510 </footnote>
1511 This includes modifications
1512 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1513 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1514 <footnote>
1515 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1516 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1517 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1518 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1519 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1520 as a non-native package.
1521 </footnote>
1522 </p>
1525 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1526 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1527 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1528 </p>
1531 That format is a series of entries like this:
1533 <example compact="compact">
1534 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1535 <var>
1536 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1537 </var>
1538 * <var>change details</var>
1539 <var>more change details</var>
1540 <var>
1541 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1542 </var>
1543 * <var>even more change details</var>
1544 <var>
1545 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1546 </var>
1547 -- <var>maintainer name</var> &lt;<var>email address</var>&gt;<var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1548 </example>
1549 </p>
1552 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1553 package name and version number.
1554 </p>
1557 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1558 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1559 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1560 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1561 </p>
1564 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1565 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1566 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1567 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1568 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1569 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1570 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1571 <tt>urgency</tt>).
1572 </p>
1575 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1576 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1577 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1578 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1579 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1580 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1581 </p>
1584 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1585 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1586 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1587 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1588 in the change details.<footnote>
1589 To be precise, the string should match the following
1590 Perl regular expression:
1591 <example>
1592 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1593 </example>
1594 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1595 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1596 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1597 </footnote>
1598 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1599 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1600 </p>
1603 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1604 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1605 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1606 usual package maintainer. The information here will be
1607 copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt> field in the
1608 <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">),
1609 and then later used to send an acknowledgement when the
1610 upload has been installed.
1611 </p>
1614 The <var>date</var> must be in RFC822 format<footnote>
1615 This is generated by <tt>date -R</tt>.
1616 </footnote>; it must include the time zone specified
1617 numerically, with the time zone name or abbreviation
1618 optionally present as a comment in parentheses.
1619 </p>
1622 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1623 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1624 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1625 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1626 separated by exactly two spaces.
1627 </p>
1630 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1631 </p>
1634 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1635 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1636 </p>
1637 </sect>
1639 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1640 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1642 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of
1643 its copyright and distribution license in the file
1644 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1645 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1646 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations relayed
1647 to copyrights for packages.
1648 </p>
1649 </sect>
1650 <sect>
1651 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1654 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1655 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1656 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1657 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1658 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1659 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1660 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1661 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1662 problems.
1663 </p>
1666 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1667 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1668 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1669 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1670 then running a program, using <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt> rather
1671 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1672 more complex commands including most loops and
1673 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1674 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1675 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1676 </p>
1677 </sect>
1679 <sect id="timestamps">
1680 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1682 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1683 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1684 possible.<footnote>
1685 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1686 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1687 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1688 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1689 modification time of the upstream source would be
1690 preserved.
1691 </footnote>
1692 </p>
1693 </sect>
1695 <sect id="restrictions">
1696 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1699 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1701 This is not currently detected when building source
1702 packages, but only when extracting
1703 them.
1704 </p>
1706 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1707 future, but would require a fair amount of
1708 work.
1709 </p>
1710 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1711 setgid files.<footnote>
1712 Setgid directories are allowed.
1713 </footnote>
1714 </p>
1715 </sect>
1717 <sect id="debianrules">
1718 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1721 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1722 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1723 building binary package(s) from the source.
1724 </p>
1727 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1728 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1729 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly.
1730 </p>
1733 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1734 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it
1735 hard for other people to reproduce the same binary
1736 package, all <em>required targets</em> MUST be
1737 non-interactive. At a minimum, required targets are the
1738 ones called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, namely,
1739 <em>clean</em>, <em>binary</em>, <em>binary-arch</em>,
1740 <em>binary-indep</em>, and <em>build</em>. It also follows
1741 that any target that these targets depend on must also be
1742 non-interactive.
1743 </p>
1746 The targets are as follows (required unless stated otherwise):
1747 <taglist>
1748 <tag><tt>build</tt></tag>
1749 <item>
1751 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1752 configuration and compilation of the package.
1753 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1754 configuration routine, the Debianized source package
1755 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1756 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1757 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1758 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1759 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1760 detected by the configuration routine.)
1761 </p>
1764 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1765 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1766 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1767 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1768 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1769 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1770 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1771 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1772 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1773 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1774 binary package out of each.
1775 </p>
1778 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1779 that might require root privilege.
1780 </p>
1783 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1784 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1785 </p>
1788 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1789 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1790 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1791 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1792 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1793 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1794 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1795 program.<footnote>
1796 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1797 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1798 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1799 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1800 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1801 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1802 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1803 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1804 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1805 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1806 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1807 targets.
1808 </footnote>
1809 </p>
1810 </item>
1812 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1813 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1814 </tag>
1815 <item>
1817 A package may also provide both of the targets
1818 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1819 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1820 perform all the configuration and compilation required
1821 for producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1822 (those packages for which the body of the
1823 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1824 is not <tt>all</tt>).
1825 Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1826 provided, should perform all the configuration and
1827 compilation required for producing all
1828 architecture-independent binary packages
1829 (those packages for which the body of the
1830 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt>
1831 is <tt>all</tt>).
1832 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1833 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1834 are provided in the rules file.
1835 </p>
1838 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1839 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1840 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1841 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1842 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1843 if the target is missing.
1844 </p>
1847 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1848 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1849 </p>
1850 </item>
1852 <tag><tt>binary</tt>, <tt>binary-arch</tt>,
1853 <tt>binary-indep</tt>
1854 </tag>
1855 <item>
1857 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1858 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1859 produced from this source package. It is
1860 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1861 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1862 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1863 those which are not.
1864 </p>
1866 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
1867 no commands which simply depends on
1868 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
1869 </p>
1871 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
1872 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
1873 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1874 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
1875 been already. It should then create the relevant
1876 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
1877 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
1878 build them and place them in the parent of the top
1879 level directory.
1880 </p>
1883 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
1884 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
1885 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
1886 the case if the source generates only a single binary
1887 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
1888 must still exist and must always succeed.
1889 </p>
1892 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
1893 root.<footnote>
1894 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
1895 to build a package correctly even without being
1896 root.
1897 </footnote>
1898 </p>
1899 </item>
1901 <tag><tt>clean</tt></tag>
1902 <item>
1904 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
1905 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
1906 that it should leave alone any output files created in
1907 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
1908 target.
1909 </p>
1912 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
1913 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
1914 should be removed as the first action that
1915 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
1916 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
1917 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
1918 already done.
1919 </p>
1922 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
1923 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
1924 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
1925 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
1926 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
1927 example).
1928 </p>
1929 </item>
1931 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
1932 <item>
1934 This target fetches the most recent version of the
1935 original source package from a canonical archive site
1936 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
1937 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
1938 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
1939 current directory.
1940 </p>
1943 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
1944 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
1945 may have left.
1946 </p>
1949 This target is optional, but providing it if
1950 possible is a good idea.
1951 </p>
1952 </item>
1954 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
1955 <item>
1957 This target performs whatever additional actions are
1958 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
1959 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
1960 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
1961 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
1962 for additional modification. See
1963 <ref id="readmesource">.
1964 </p>
1965 </item>
1966 </taglist>
1969 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
1970 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
1971 directory being the package's top-level directory.
1972 </p>
1976 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
1977 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
1978 package's internal use.
1979 </p>
1982 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
1983 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the utility
1984 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
1985 You can determine the
1986 Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture
1987 specification string for the build machine (the machine type
1988 we are building on) as well as for the host machine (the
1989 machine type we are building for). Here is a list of
1990 supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
1991 <list compact="compact">
1992 <item>
1993 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
1994 </item>
1995 <item>
1996 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
1997 </item>
1998 <item>
1999 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2000 </item>
2001 <item>
2002 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2003 specification string)
2004 </item>
2005 <item>
2006 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2007 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2008 </item>
2009 <item>
2010 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2011 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2012 </list>
2013 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2014 the build machine or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2015 host machine.
2016 </p>
2019 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2020 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2021 values; please refer to the documentation of
2022 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2023 </p>
2026 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2027 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2028 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2029 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2030 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2031 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2032 build systems.
2033 </p>
2035 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2036 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2037 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2040 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2041 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2042 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2043 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2044 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2045 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2046 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2047 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2048 flag values that contain commas.
2049 </footnote>
2050 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2051 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2052 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2053 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2054 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2055 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2056 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2057 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2058 </p>
2061 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2062 <taglist>
2063 <tag>nocheck</tag>
2064 <item>
2065 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2066 provided by the package.
2067 </item>
2068 <tag>noopt</tag>
2069 <item>
2070 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2071 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2072 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2073 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2074 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2075 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2076 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2077 </item>
2078 <tag>nostrip</tag>
2079 <item>
2080 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2081 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2082 debugging information may be included in the package.
2083 </item>
2084 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2085 <item>
2086 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2087 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2088 system supports this.<footnote>
2089 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2090 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2091 <tt>make</tt>.
2092 </footnote>
2093 If the package build system does not support parallel
2094 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2095 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2096 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2097 many parallel processes as the package build system
2098 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2099 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2100 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2101 parallel builds worthwhile.
2102 </item>
2103 </taglist>
2104 </p>
2107 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2108 </p>
2111 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2112 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2113 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2114 package.
2115 <example compact="compact">
2116 CFLAGS = -Wall -g
2117 INSTALL = install
2118 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2119 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2120 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2121 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2123 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2124 CFLAGS += -O0
2125 else
2126 CFLAGS += -O2
2127 endif
2128 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2129 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2130 endif
2131 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2132 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2133 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2134 endif
2136 build:
2137 # ...
2138 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2139 # Code to run the package test suite.
2140 endif
2141 </example>
2142 </p>
2143 </sect1>
2144 </sect>
2146 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2147 <sect id="substvars">
2148 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2151 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2152 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2153 generate control files they perform variable substitutions
2154 on their output just before writing it. Variable
2155 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2156 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2157 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2158 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2159 option to the source packaging commands, and certain
2160 predefined variables are also available.
2161 </p>
2164 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2165 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2166 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2167 </p>
2170 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2171 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2172 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2173 </sect>
2175 <sect id="debianwatch">
2176 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2179 This is an optional, recommended control file for the
2180 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically
2181 scan ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2182 package. This is used by <url id="
2183 http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA tools
2184 to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2185 distribution as a whole.
2186 </p>
2188 </sect>
2190 <sect id="debianfiles">
2191 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2194 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2195 is used while building packages to record which files are
2196 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2197 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2198 </p>
2201 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2202 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2203 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2204 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2205 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2206 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2207 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2208 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2209 occurs.
2210 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2211 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2212 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2213 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2214 </p>
2217 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2218 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2219 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2220 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2221 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2222 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2223 </p>
2226 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2227 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2228 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2229 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2230 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2231 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2232 </sect>
2234 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2235 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2238 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2239 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2240 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2241 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2242 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2243 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2244 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2245 </footnote>
2246 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2247 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2248 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2249 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2250 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2251 prerequisite if possible.
2252 <footnote>
2253 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2254 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2255 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2256 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2257 duplicated code.
2258 </footnote>
2259 </p>
2260 </sect>
2262 <sect id="readmesource">
2263 <heading>Source package handling:
2264 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2267 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2268 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2269 and allow one to make changes and run
2270 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2271 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2272 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2273 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2274 following:
2275 <enumlist>
2276 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2277 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2278 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2279 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2280 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2281 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2282 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2283 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2284 applied when building the package.</item>
2285 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2286 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2287 if applicable.</item>
2288 </enumlist>
2289 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2290 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2291 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2292 management tools.
2293 </p>
2296 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2297 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2298 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2299 a general reference manual.
2300 </p>
2303 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2304 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2305 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2306 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2307 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2308 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2309 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2310 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2311 </p>
2312 </sect>
2313 </chapt>
2316 <chapt id="controlfields">
2317 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2320 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2321 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2322 <em>control files</em>.
2323 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2324 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2325 of uploaded files<footnote>
2326 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2327 format.
2328 </footnote>.
2329 </p>
2331 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2332 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2335 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2336 fields<footnote>
2337 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2338 </footnote>.
2339 The paragraphs are separated by blank lines. Some control
2340 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2341 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2342 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2343 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2344 refer to binary packages generated from the source.)
2345 </p>
2348 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2349 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2350 then the data/value associated with that field. It ends at
2351 the end of the (logical) line. Horizontal whitespace
2352 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2353 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2354 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2356 <example compact="compact">
2357 Package: libc6
2358 </example>
2359 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2360 <tt>libc6</tt>.
2361 </p>
2364 Many fields' values may span several lines; in this case
2365 each continuation line must start with a space or a tab.
2366 Any trailing spaces or tabs at the end of individual
2367 lines of a field value are ignored.
2368 </p>
2371 In fields where it is specified that lines may not wrap,
2372 only a single line of data is allowed and whitespace is not
2373 significant in a field body. Whitespace must not appear
2374 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2375 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2376 multi-character version relationships.
2377 </p>
2380 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2381 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2382 </p>
2385 Blank lines, or lines consisting only of spaces and tabs,
2386 are not allowed within field values or between fields - that
2387 would mean a new paragraph.
2388 </p>
2391 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2392 </p>
2393 </sect>
2395 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2396 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2399 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2400 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2401 and about the binary packages it creates.
2402 </p>
2405 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2406 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2407 binary package that the source tree builds.
2408 </p>
2411 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2412 package) are:
2414 <list compact="compact">
2415 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2416 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2417 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2418 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2419 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2420 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2421 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2422 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2423 </list>
2424 </p>
2427 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2429 <list compact="compact">
2430 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2431 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2432 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2433 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2434 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2435 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2436 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2437 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2438 </list>
2439 </p>
2442 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2443 </p>
2445 <!-- stuff -->
2448 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2449 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2450 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2451 <tt>.changes</tt> file to accompany the upload, and by
2452 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2453 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2454 archive. Many fields are permitted to span multiple lines in
2455 <file>debian/control</file> but not in any other control
2456 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2457 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2458 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2459 </p>
2462 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2463 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2464 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2465 when they generate output control files.
2466 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2467 </p>
2470 In addition to the control file syntax described <qref
2471 id="controlsyntax">above</qref>, this file may also contain
2472 comment lines starting with <tt>#</tt> without any preceding
2473 whitespace. All such lines are ignored, even in the middle of
2474 continuation lines for a multiline field, and do not end a
2475 multiline field.
2476 </p>
2478 </sect>
2480 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2481 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2484 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2485 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package.
2486 </p>
2489 The fields in this file are:
2491 <list compact="compact">
2492 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2493 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2494 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2495 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2496 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2497 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2498 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2499 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2500 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2501 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2502 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2503 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2504 </list>
2505 </p>
2506 </sect>
2508 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2509 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2512 This file contains a series of fields, identified and
2513 separated just like the fields in the control file of
2514 a binary package. The fields are listed below; their
2515 syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2517 <list compact="compact">
2518 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2519 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2520 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2521 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2522 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2523 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2524 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2525 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2526 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2527 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2528 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2529 </list>
2530 </p>
2533 The source package control file is generated by
2534 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2535 archive, from other files in the source package,
2536 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2537 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2538 source package.
2539 </p>
2541 </sect>
2543 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2544 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2547 The .changes files are used by the Debian archive maintenance
2548 software to process updates to packages. They contain one
2549 paragraph which contains information from the
2550 <tt>debian/control</tt> file and other data about the
2551 source package gathered via <tt>debian/changelog</tt>
2552 and <tt>debian/rules</tt>.
2553 </p>
2556 The fields in this file are:
2558 <list compact="compact">
2559 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2560 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2561 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2562 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2563 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2564 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2565 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2566 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2567 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2568 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2569 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2570 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2571 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2572 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2573 </list>
2574 </p>
2575 </sect>
2577 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2578 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2580 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2581 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2584 This field identifies the source package name.
2585 </p>
2588 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2589 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2590 </p>
2593 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2594 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2595 number in parentheses<footnote>
2596 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2597 if a version number is specified.
2598 </footnote>.
2599 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2600 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2601 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2602 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2603 package control file when the source package has the same
2604 name and version as the binary package.
2605 </p>
2608 Package names (both source and binary,
2609 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2610 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2611 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2612 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2613 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2614 </p>
2615 </sect1>
2617 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2618 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2621 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2622 should come first, then the email address inside angle
2623 brackets <tt>&lt;&gt</tt> (in RFC822 format).
2624 </p>
2627 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2628 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2629 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2630 program using this field as an address must check for this
2631 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2632 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2633 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2634 </p>
2635 </sect1>
2637 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2638 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2641 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of
2642 the package, if any. If the package has other maintainers
2643 beside the one named in the
2644 <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</qref>, their
2645 names and email addresses should be listed here. The
2646 format is the same as that of the Maintainer tag, and
2647 multiple entries should be comma separated. Currently,
2648 this field is restricted to a single line of data. This
2649 is an optional field.
2650 </p>
2652 Any parser that interprets the Uploaders field in
2653 <file>debian/control</file> must permit it to span multiple
2654 lines. Line breaks in an Uploaders field that spans multiple
2655 lines are not significant and the semantics of the field are
2656 the same as if the line breaks had not been present.
2657 </p>
2658 </sect1>
2660 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2661 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2664 The name and email address of the person who changed the
2665 said package. Usually the name of the maintainer.
2666 All the rules for the Maintainer field apply here, too.
2667 </p>
2668 </sect1>
2670 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2671 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2674 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2675 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2676 </p>
2679 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2680 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2681 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2682 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2683 packages.
2684 </p>
2685 </sect1>
2687 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2688 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2691 This field represents how important that it is that the user
2692 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2693 </p>
2696 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2697 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2698 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2699 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2700 packages.
2701 </p>
2702 </sect1>
2704 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2705 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2708 The name of the binary package.
2709 </p>
2712 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2713 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2714 for the details.
2715 </p>
2716 </sect1>
2718 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2719 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2722 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2723 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2724 values:
2725 <list>
2726 <item>A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2727 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2728 <item><tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2729 architecture-independent package.
2730 <item><tt>any</tt>, which indicates a package available
2731 for building on any architecture.
2732 <item><tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2733 </list>
2734 </p>
2737 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2738 package, this field may contain the special value
2739 <tt>any</tt>, the special value <tt>all</tt>, or a list of
2740 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>any</tt> or
2741 <tt>all</tt> appear, they must be the entire contents of the
2742 field. Most packages will use either <tt>any</tt> or
2743 <tt>all</tt>. Specifying a specific list of architectures is
2744 for the minority of cases where a program is not portable or
2745 is not useful on some architectures, and where possible the
2746 program should be made portable instead.
2747 </p>
2750 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2751 field may contain either the special value <tt>any</tt> or a
2752 list of architectures separated by spaces. If a list is given,
2753 it may include (or consist solely of) the special value
2754 <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file> files
2755 unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may occur
2756 in combination with specific architectures. The
2757 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control file
2758 <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from the
2759 <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in the
2760 <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2761 </p>
2764 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2765 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2766 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2767 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2768 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2769 </p>
2772 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
2773 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
2774 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
2775 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
2776 least one architecture-dependent package.
2777 </p>
2780 Specifying a list of architectures indicates that the source
2781 will build an architecture-dependent package, and will only
2782 work correctly on the listed architectures. If the source
2783 package also builds at least one architecture-independent
2784 package, <tt>all</tt> will also be included in the list.
2785 </p>
2788 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
2789 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s)
2790 currently being uploaded. This will be a list; if the
2791 source for the package is also being uploaded, the special
2792 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
2793 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
2794 uploaded. <tt>any</tt> may never occur in the
2795 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the <file>.changes</file>
2796 file.
2797 </p>
2800 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information how to get the
2801 architecture for the build process.
2802 </p>
2803 </sect1>
2805 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
2806 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
2809 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
2810 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
2811 paragraph of a main source control data file.
2812 </p>
2815 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
2816 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
2817 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
2818 which is the same as not having the field at all.
2819 </p>
2820 </sect1>
2822 <sect1>
2823 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
2824 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
2825 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
2826 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
2827 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
2828 </heading>
2831 These fields describe the package's relationships with
2832 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
2833 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
2834 </sect1>
2836 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
2837 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
2840 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
2841 manual and associated texts) with which the package
2842 complies.
2843 </p>
2846 The version number has four components: major and minor
2847 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
2848 standards change in a way that requires every package to
2849 change the major number will be changed. Significant
2850 changes that will require work in many packages will be
2851 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
2852 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
2853 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
2854 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
2855 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
2856 nor affect the contents of packages.
2857 </p>
2860 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
2861 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
2862 field, and so either these three components or the all
2863 four components may be specified.<footnote>
2864 In the past, people specified the full version number
2865 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
2866 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
2867 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
2868 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
2869 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
2870 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
2871 </footnote>
2872 </p>
2874 </sect1>
2876 <sect1 id="f-Version">
2877 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
2880 The version number of a package. The format is:
2881 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
2882 </p>
2885 The three components here are:
2886 <taglist>
2887 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
2888 <item>
2890 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
2891 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
2892 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
2893 contain any colons.
2894 </p>
2897 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
2898 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
2899 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
2900 </p>
2901 </item>
2903 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
2904 <item>
2906 This is the main part of the version number. It is
2907 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
2908 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
2909 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
2910 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
2911 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
2912 package management system's format and comparison
2913 scheme.
2914 </p>
2917 The comparison behavior of the package management system
2918 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
2919 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
2920 portion of the version number is mandatory.
2921 </p>
2924 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
2925 alphanumerics<footnote>
2926 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
2927 </footnote>
2928 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
2929 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
2930 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
2931 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
2932 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
2933 allowed.
2934 </p>
2935 </item>
2937 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
2938 <item>
2940 This part of the version number specifies the version of
2941 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
2942 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
2943 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
2944 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
2945 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
2946 </p>
2949 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
2950 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
2951 This format represents the case where a piece of
2952 software was written specifically to be turned into a
2953 Debian package, and so there is only one "debianisation"
2954 of it and therefore no revision indication is required.
2955 </p>
2958 It is conventional to restart the
2959 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
2960 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
2961 </p>
2964 The package management system will break the version
2965 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
2966 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
2967 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
2968 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
2969 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
2970 </p>
2971 </item>
2972 </taglist>
2973 </p>
2976 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
2977 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
2978 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
2979 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
2980 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
2981 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
2982 parts are compared by the package management system using the
2983 following algorithm:
2984 </p>
2987 The strings are compared from left to right.
2988 </p>
2991 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
2992 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
2993 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
2994 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
2995 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
2996 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
2997 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
2998 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
2999 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3000 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3001 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3002 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3003 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3004 </footnote>
3005 </p>
3008 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3009 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3010 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3011 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3012 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3013 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3014 as zero.
3015 </p>
3018 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3019 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3020 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3021 </p>
3024 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3025 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3026 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3027 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3028 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3029 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3030 silly orderings (the author of this manual has heard of a
3031 package whose versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>,
3032 <tt>1.3</tt>, <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>,
3033 <tt>2</tt> and so forth).
3034 </p>
3035 </sect1>
3037 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3038 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3041 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3042 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3043 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3044 long description. The field's format is as follows:
3045 </p>
3048 <example>
3049 Description: &lt;single line synopsis&gt;
3050 &lt;extended description over several lines&gt;
3051 </example>
3052 </p>
3055 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3056 </p>
3058 <p><list>
3060 <item>
3061 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3062 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3063 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3064 </item>
3066 <item>
3067 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3068 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3069 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3070 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3071 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3072 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3073 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3074 indenting work correctly, for example).
3075 </item>
3077 <item>
3078 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3079 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3080 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3081 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3082 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3083 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3084 likely abort with an error.
3085 </footnote>.
3086 </item>
3088 <item>
3089 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3090 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3091 </item>
3093 </list></p>
3096 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3097 </p>
3100 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3101 </p>
3104 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt> field
3105 contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages being
3106 uploaded.
3107 </p>
3110 The part of the field before the first newline is empty;
3111 thereafter each line has the name of a binary package and
3112 the summary description line from that binary package.
3113 Each line is indented by one space.
3114 </p>
3116 </sect1>
3118 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3119 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3122 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3123 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3124 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3125 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3126 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3127 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3128 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3129 <taglist compact="compact">
3130 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3131 <item>
3132 This distribution value refers to the
3133 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3134 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3135 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3136 directory tree.
3137 </item>
3139 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3140 <item>
3141 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3142 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3143 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3144 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3145 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3146 of the Debian distribution tree.
3147 </item>
3148 </taglist>
3151 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3152 security uploads. More information is available in the
3153 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3154 archive".
3155 </p>
3156 </footnote>
3157 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3158 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3159 handled outside of the upload process.
3160 </p>
3161 </sect1>
3163 <sect1 id="f-Date">
3164 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3167 This field includes the date the package was built or last edited.
3168 </p>
3171 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3172 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3173 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3174 </p>
3175 </sect1>
3177 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3178 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3181 This field specifies a format revision for the file.
3182 The most current format described in the Policy Manual
3183 is version <strong>1.5</strong>. The syntax of the
3184 format value is the same as that of a package version
3185 number except that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed
3186 - see <ref id="f-Version">.
3187 </p>
3188 </sect1>
3190 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3191 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3194 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3195 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3196 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3197 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3198 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3199 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3200 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3201 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3202 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3203 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3204 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3205 treated as synonymous.
3206 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3207 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3208 parentheses. For example:
3210 <example>
3211 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3212 </example>
3214 </p>
3217 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3218 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3219 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3220 </p>
3221 </sect1>
3223 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3224 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3227 This field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3228 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3229 </p>
3232 There should be nothing in this field before the first
3233 newline; all the subsequent lines must be indented by at
3234 least one space; blank lines must be represented by a line
3235 consisting only of a space and a full stop.
3236 </p>
3239 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3240 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3241 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3242 </p>
3245 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3246 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3247 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3248 </p>
3251 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3252 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3253 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3254 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3255 representation of blank line).
3256 </p>
3257 </sect1>
3259 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3260 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3263 This field is a list of binary packages.
3264 </p>
3267 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file it is the list
3268 of binary packages which a source package can produce. It
3269 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages
3270 for every architecture. The source control file doesn't
3271 contain details of which architectures are appropriate for
3272 which of the binary packages.
3273 </p>
3276 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file it lists the
3277 names of the binary packages actually being uploaded.
3278 </p>
3281 The syntax is a list of binary packages separated by
3282 commas<footnote>
3283 A space after each comma is conventional.
3284 </footnote>. Currently the packages must be separated using
3285 only spaces in the <file>.changes</file> file.
3286 </p>
3287 </sect1>
3289 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3290 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3293 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3294 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3295 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3296 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3297 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3298 maintainer scripts.
3299 </p>
3302 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3303 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3304 </p>
3305 </sect1>
3307 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3308 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3311 This field contains a list of files with information about
3312 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3313 the context. In all cases the part of the field
3314 contents on the same line as the field name is empty. The
3315 remainder of the field is one line per file, each line
3316 being indented by one space and containing a number of
3317 sub-fields separated by spaces.
3318 </p>
3321 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3322 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if applicable)
3323 diff file which make up the remainder of the source
3324 package<footnote>
3325 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3326 </footnote>.
3327 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3328 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3329 </p>
3332 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3333 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3334 size, section and priority and the filename.
3335 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3336 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref>
3337 are the values of the corresponding fields in
3338 the main source control file. If no section or priority is
3339 specified then <tt>-</tt> should be used, though section
3340 and priority values must be specified for new packages to
3341 be installed properly.
3342 </p>
3345 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3346 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3347 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3348 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3349 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3350 </p>
3353 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3354 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3355 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3356 entry for the original source archive
3357 <file><var>package</var>-<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3358 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3359 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3360 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3361 source archive which was used to generate the
3362 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3363 </sect1>
3365 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3366 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3369 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3370 governed by the .changes file closes.
3371 </p>
3372 </sect1>
3374 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3375 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3378 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3379 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3380 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3381 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3382 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3383 <tt>&lt;&gt;</tt>.
3384 </p>
3385 </sect1>
3387 </sect>
3389 <sect>
3390 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3393 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3394 source package control file. Such fields will be
3395 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3396 source package control files or upload control files.
3397 </p>
3400 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3401 these output files you should use the mechanism
3402 described here.
3403 </p>
3406 Fields in the main source control information file with
3407 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3408 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3409 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3410 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3411 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3412 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3413 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3414 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3415 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3416 </p>
3419 For example, if the main source information control file
3420 contains the field
3421 <example>
3422 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3423 </example>
3424 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3425 field
3426 <example>
3427 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3428 </example>
3429 </p>
3431 </sect>
3433 </chapt>
3436 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3437 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3439 <sect>
3440 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3443 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3444 the package management system will run for you when your
3445 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3446 </p>
3449 These scripts are the files <prgn>preinst</prgn>,
3450 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> and
3451 <prgn>postrm</prgn> in the control area of the package.
3452 They must be proper executable files; if they are scripts
3453 (which is recommended), they must start with the usual
3454 <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3455 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3456 </p>
3459 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3460 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3461 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3462 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3463 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3464 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3465 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3466 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3467 </p>
3470 Additionally, packages interacting with users using
3471 <tt>debconf</tt> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script should
3472 install a <prgn>config</prgn> script in the control area,
3473 see <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3474 </p>
3477 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3478 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3479 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3480 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3481 check the arguments to your scripts.
3482 </p>
3485 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3486 (a particular version of) a package is installed, and the
3487 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3488 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3489 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3490 </p>
3493 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3494 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3495 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3496 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3497 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3498 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3499 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3500 other program that one would expect to be in the
3501 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3502 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3503 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3504 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3505 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3506 </sect>
3508 <sect id="idempotency">
3509 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3512 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3513 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3514 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3515 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3516 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3517 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3518 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3519 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3520 is OK.<footnote>
3521 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3522 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3523 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3524 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3525 action.
3526 </footnote>
3527 </p>
3528 </sect>
3530 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3531 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3534 The maintainer scripts are guaranteed to run with a
3535 controlling terminal and can interact with the user.
3536 Because these scripts may be executed with standard output
3537 redirected into a pipe for logging purposes, Perl scripts
3538 should set unbuffered output by setting <tt>$|=1</tt> so
3539 that the output is printed immediately rather than being
3540 buffered.
3541 </p>
3542 </sect>
3543 <sect id="exitstatus">
3544 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3547 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3548 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3549 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3550 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3551 </p>
3552 </sect>
3554 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3555 scripts are called
3556 </heading>
3559 <list compact="compact">
3560 <item>
3561 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3562 </item>
3563 <item>
3564 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3565 </item>
3566 <item>
3567 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3568 </item>
3569 <item>
3570 <var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3571 <var>new-version</var>
3572 </item>
3573 </list>
3576 <list compact="compact">
3577 <item>
3578 <var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3579 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
3580 </item>
3581 <item>
3582 <var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3583 <var>new-version</var>
3584 </item>
3585 <item>
3586 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3587 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3588 <var>new-version</var>
3589 </item>
3590 <item>
3591 <var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3592 </item>
3593 <item>
3594 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3595 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3596 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3597 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3598 <var>version</var>]
3599 </item>
3600 </list>
3603 <list compact="compact">
3604 <item>
3605 <var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3606 </item>
3607 <item>
3608 <var>old-prerm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3609 <var>new-version</var>
3610 </item>
3611 <item>
3612 <var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3613 <var>old-version</var>
3614 </item>
3615 <item>
3616 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3617 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3618 <var>new-version</var>
3619 </item>
3620 <item>
3621 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
3622 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
3623 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
3624 <var>conflicting-package</var>
3625 <var>version</var>]
3626 </item>
3627 </list>
3630 <list compact="compact">
3631 <item>
3632 <var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3633 </item>
3634 <item>
3635 <var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt>
3636 </item>
3637 <item>
3638 <var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3639 <var>new-version</var>
3640 </item>
3641 <item>
3642 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3643 <var>old-version</var>
3644 </item>
3645 <item>
3646 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3647 </item>
3648 <item>
3649 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3650 <var>old-version</var>
3651 </item>
3652 <item>
3653 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3654 <var>old-version</var>
3655 </item>
3656 <item>
3657 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
3658 <var>overwriter</var>
3659 <var>overwriter-version</var>
3660 </item>
3661 </list>
3662 </p>
3665 <sect id="unpackphase">
3666 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
3669 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
3670 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
3671 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
3672 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
3673 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
3674 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
3675 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
3676 below.
3678 <enumlist>
3679 <item>
3680 <enumlist>
3681 <item>
3682 If a version of the package is already installed, call
3683 <example compact="compact">
3684 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3685 </example>
3686 </item>
3687 <item>
3688 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
3689 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3690 <example compact="compact">
3691 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3692 </example>
3693 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
3694 does not work, the error unwind:
3695 <example compact="compact">
3696 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3697 </example>
3698 If this works, then the old-version is
3699 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
3700 "Failed-Config" state.
3701 </item>
3702 </enumlist>
3703 </item>
3705 <item>
3706 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
3707 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
3708 <enumlist>
3709 <item>
3710 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3711 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
3712 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
3713 <example compact="compact">
3714 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3715 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
3716 </example>
3717 Error unwind:
3718 <example compact="compact">
3719 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3720 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
3721 </example>
3722 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3723 requiring configuration, so that if
3724 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3725 configured again if possible.
3726 </item>
3727 <item>
3728 If any packages depended on a conflicting
3729 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3730 specified, call, for each such package:
3731 <example compact="compact">
3732 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3733 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
3734 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3735 </example>
3736 Error unwind:
3737 <example compact="compact">
3738 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3739 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
3740 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3741 </example>
3742 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3743 requiring configuration, so that if
3744 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3745 configured again if possible.
3746 </item>
3747 <item>
3748 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
3749 <example compact="compact">
3750 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
3751 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3752 </example>
3753 Error unwind:
3754 <example compact="compact">
3755 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
3756 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3757 </example>
3758 </item>
3759 </enumlist>
3760 </item>
3762 <item>
3763 <enumlist>
3764 <item>
3765 If the package is being upgraded, call:
3766 <example compact="compact">
3767 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3768 </example>
3769 If this fails, we call:
3770 <example>
3771 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3772 </example>
3773 <enumlist>
3774 <item>
3776 If that works, then
3777 <example>
3778 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3779 </example>
3780 is called. If this works, then the old version
3781 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
3782 in an "Unpacked" state.
3783 </p>
3784 </item>
3785 <item>
3787 If it fails, then the old version is left
3788 in an "Half-Installed" state.
3789 </p>
3790 </item>
3791 </enumlist>
3793 </item>
3794 <item>
3795 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
3796 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
3797 is in the "configuration files only" state):
3798 <example compact="compact">
3799 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
3800 </example>
3801 Error unwind:
3802 <example>
3803 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
3804 </example>
3805 If this fails, the package is left in a
3806 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
3807 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
3808 a "Config Files" state.
3809 </item>
3810 <item>
3811 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
3812 <example compact="compact">
3813 <var>new-preinst</var> install
3814 </example>
3815 Error unwind:
3816 <example compact="compact">
3817 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
3818 </example>
3819 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
3820 "Half Installed" phase, and requires a
3821 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
3822 package is in a not installed state.
3823 </item>
3824 </enumlist>
3825 </item>
3827 <item>
3829 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
3830 that may be on the system already, for example any
3831 from the old version of the same package or from
3832 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
3833 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
3834 management system will attempt to put them back as
3835 part of the error unwind.
3836 </p>
3839 It is an error for a package to contain files which
3840 are on the system in another package, unless
3841 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
3842 <!--
3843 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
3844 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
3845 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
3846 always be the case.
3848 </p>
3851 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
3852 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
3853 package has a directory (again, unless
3854 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
3855 overridden if desired using
3856 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
3857 advisable.
3858 </p>
3861 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
3862 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
3863 system administrator to understand. It can easily
3864 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
3865 is installed which overwrites a file from another
3866 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
3867 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
3868 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
3869 </footnote>
3870 </p>
3873 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
3874 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
3875 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
3876 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
3877 one.
3878 </p>
3879 </item>
3881 <item>
3883 <enumlist>
3884 <item>
3885 If the package is being upgraded, call
3886 <example compact="compact">
3887 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3888 </example>
3889 </item>
3890 <item>
3891 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3892 <example compact="compact">
3893 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3894 </example>
3895 If this works, installation continues. If not,
3896 Error unwind:
3897 <example compact="compact">
3898 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3899 </example>
3900 If this fails, the old version is left in an
3901 "Half Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
3902 calls:
3903 <example compact="compact">
3904 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3905 </example>
3906 If this fails, the old version is left in an
3907 "Half Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
3908 calls:
3909 <example compact="compact">
3910 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3911 </example>
3912 If this fails, the old version is in an
3913 "Unpacked" state.
3914 </item>
3915 </enumlist>
3916 </p>
3919 This is the point of no return - if
3920 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
3921 past this point if an error occurs. This will
3922 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
3923 will require a successful re-installation to clear
3924 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
3925 things that are irreversible.
3926 </p>
3927 </item>
3929 <item>
3930 Any files which were in the old version of the package
3931 but not in the new are removed.
3932 </item>
3934 <item>
3935 The new file list replaces the old.
3936 </item>
3938 <item>
3939 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
3940 </item>
3942 <item>
3943 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
3944 during the installation, and which aren't required for
3945 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
3946 For each such package
3947 <enumlist>
3948 <item>
3949 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
3950 <example compact="compact">
3951 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
3952 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
3953 </example>
3954 </item>
3955 <item>
3956 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
3957 </item>
3958 <item>
3959 It is noted in the status database as being in a
3960 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
3961 it may have are ignored, rather than being
3962 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
3963 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
3964 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
3965 in advance that the package is going to
3966 vanish.
3967 </item>
3968 </enumlist>
3969 </item>
3971 <item>
3972 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
3973 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
3974 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
3975 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
3976 </item>
3978 <item>
3979 The backup files made during installation, above, are
3980 deleted.
3981 </item>
3983 <item>
3985 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
3986 "unpacked".
3987 </p>
3990 Here is another point of no return - if the
3991 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
3992 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
3993 is left in a half-removed limbo.
3994 </p>
3995 </item>
3997 <item>
3998 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
3999 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4000 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4001 are also in the package being installed have already
4002 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4003 and so do not get removed now).
4004 </item>
4005 </enumlist>
4006 </p>
4007 </sect>
4009 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4012 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4013 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4014 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4015 <example compact="compact">
4016 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4017 </example>
4018 </p>
4021 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4022 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4023 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4024 </p>
4027 If there is no most recently configured version
4028 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4029 <footnote>
4031 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4032 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt>&lt;unknown&gt;</tt>
4033 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4034 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4035 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4036 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4037 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4038 </p>
4039 </footnote>
4040 </p>
4041 </sect>
4043 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4044 configuration purging</heading>
4047 <enumlist>
4048 <item>
4050 <example compact="compact">
4051 <var>prerm</var> remove
4052 </example>
4053 </p>
4055 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4056 <example>
4057 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4058 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4059 </example>
4060 Or else we call:
4061 <example>
4062 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4063 </example>
4064 </p>
4066 If this fails, the package is in a "Failed-Config"
4067 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4068 </p>
4069 </item>
4070 <item>
4071 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4072 </item>
4073 <item>
4074 <example compact="compact">
4075 <var>postrm</var> remove
4076 </example>
4079 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4080 an "Half-Installed" state.
4081 </p>
4082 </item>
4083 <item>
4085 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4086 are removed.
4087 </p>
4090 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4091 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4092 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4093 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4094 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4095 </p>
4096 </item>
4097 <item>
4098 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4099 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4100 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4101 are removed.
4102 </item>
4103 <item>
4105 <example compact="compact">
4106 <var>postrm</var> purge
4107 </example>
4108 </p>
4110 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4111 state.
4112 </p>
4113 </item>
4114 <item>
4115 The package's file list is removed.
4116 </item>
4117 </enumlist>
4119 </p>
4120 </sect>
4121 </chapt>
4124 <chapt id="relationships">
4125 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4127 <sect id="depsyntax">
4128 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4131 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4132 package names separated by commas.
4133 </p>
4136 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4137 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4138 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4139 control file fields of the package, which declare
4140 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4141 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4142 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4143 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4144 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4145 </p>
4148 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4149 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4150 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4151 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4152 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4153 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4154 </p>
4157 The relations allowed are <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;=</tt>,
4158 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>&gt;=</tt> and <tt>&gt;&gt;</tt> for
4159 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4160 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4161 forms <tt>&lt;</tt> and <tt>&gt;</tt> were used to mean
4162 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4163 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4164 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4165 </p>
4168 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4169 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4170 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4171 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4172 relationship fields may span multiple lines. For
4173 consistency and in case of future changes to
4174 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4175 used after a version relationship and before a version
4176 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4177 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4178 each open parenthesis. When wrapping a relationship field, it
4179 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4180 following that comma.
4181 </p>
4184 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4185 <example compact="compact">
4186 Package: mutt
4187 Version: 1.3.17-1
4188 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4189 </example>
4190 </p>
4193 All fields that specify build-time relationships
4194 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4195 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>)
4196 may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This
4197 is indicated in brackets after each individual package name and
4198 the optional version specification. The brackets enclose a
4199 list of Debian architecture names separated by whitespace.
4200 Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the names.
4201 (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with
4202 exclamation marks while others aren't.) If the current Debian
4203 host architecture is not in this list and there are no
4204 exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list with a
4205 prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4206 associated version specification are ignored completely for
4207 the purposes of defining the relationships.
4208 </p>
4211 For example:
4212 <example compact="compact">
4213 Source: glibc
4214 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4215 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4216 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4217 </example>
4218 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4219 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4220 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4221 </p>
4224 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4225 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4226 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4227 For example:
4228 <example compact="compact">
4229 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4230 </example>
4231 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4232 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4233 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4234 </p>
4237 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4238 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4239 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4240 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4241 source package section of the control file (which is the
4242 first section).
4243 </p>
4244 </sect>
4246 <sect id="binarydeps">
4247 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4248 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4249 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4250 </heading>
4253 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4254 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4255 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4256 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4257 </p>
4260 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4261 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4262 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control file fields.
4263 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4264 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4265 rest are described below.
4266 </p>
4269 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4270 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4271 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4272 depending (binary) package's control file.
4273 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4274 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4275 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4276 break).
4277 </p>
4280 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4281 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4282 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4283 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4284 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4285 properly installed with a different version whose
4286 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4287 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4288 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4289 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4290 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4291 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4292 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4293 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4294 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4295 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4296 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4297 </p>
4300 For this reason packages in an installation run are usually
4301 all unpacked first and all configured later; this gives
4302 later versions of packages with dependencies on later
4303 versions of other packages the opportunity to have their
4304 dependencies satisfied.
4305 </p>
4308 In case of circular dependencies, since installation or
4309 removal order honoring the dependency order can't be
4310 established, dependency loops are broken at some point
4311 (based on rules below), and some packages may not be able to
4312 rely on their dependencies being present when being
4313 installed or removed, depending on which side of the break
4314 of the circular dependency loop they happen to be on. If one
4315 of the packages in the loop has no postinst script, then the
4316 cycle will be broken at that package, so as to ensure that
4317 all postinst scripts run with the dependencies properly
4318 configured if this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point
4319 is arbitrary.
4320 </p>
4323 The <tt>Depends</tt> field thus allows package maintainers
4324 to impose an order in which packages should be configured.
4325 </p>
4328 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4329 <taglist>
4330 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4331 <item>
4333 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4334 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4335 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4336 configured.
4337 </p>
4340 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4341 depended-on package is required for the depending
4342 package to provide a significant amount of
4343 functionality.
4344 </p>
4347 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4348 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4349 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts require the package to be
4350 present in order to run. Note, however, that the
4351 <prgn>postrm</prgn> cannot rely on any non-essential
4352 packages to be present during the <tt>purge</tt>
4353 phase.
4354 </item>
4356 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4357 <item>
4359 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4360 </p>
4363 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4364 that would be found together with this one in all but
4365 unusual installations.
4366 </p>
4367 </item>
4369 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4370 <item>
4371 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4372 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4373 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4374 listed packages are related to this one and can
4375 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4376 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4377 </item>
4379 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4380 <item>
4381 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4382 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4383 package can enhance the functionality of another
4384 package.
4385 </item>
4387 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4388 <item>
4390 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4391 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4392 of the packages named before even starting the
4393 installation of the package which declares the
4394 pre-dependency, as follows:
4395 </p>
4398 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4399 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4400 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4401 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4402 package(s) are only unpacked or half-configured,
4403 provided that they have been configured correctly at
4404 some point in the past (and not removed or partially
4405 removed since). In this case, both the
4406 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4407 half-configured versions must satisfy any version
4408 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4409 </p>
4412 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about
4413 to be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be
4414 treated as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>, that is, it will
4415 be considered satisfied only if the depended-on
4416 package has been correctly configured.
4417 </p>
4420 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4421 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4422 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4423 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4424 </p>
4427 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4428 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named
4429 package. It is best to avoid this situation if
4430 possible.
4431 </p>
4432 </item>
4433 </taglist>
4434 </p>
4437 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4438 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4439 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4440 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4441 importance. Such a package should list using
4442 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4443 more important components. The other components'
4444 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4445 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4446 importance.
4447 </p>
4448 </sect>
4450 <sect id="breaks">
4451 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4454 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4455 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4456 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> be installed unless the broken
4457 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4458 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4459 </p>
4462 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4463 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4464 be at least half-installed.
4465 </p>
4468 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4469 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4470 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4471 breakage.
4472 </p>
4475 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4476 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4477 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which
4478 violates an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions
4479 of the broken package. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt> will
4480 inform higher-level package management tools that broken
4481 package must be upgraded before the new one.
4482 </p>
4485 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4486 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> (not
4487 <tt>Conflicts</tt>) to ensure this goes smoothly.
4488 </p>
4489 </sect>
4491 <sect id="conflicts">
4492 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
4495 When one binary package declares a conflict with another
4496 using a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4497 refuse to allow them to be installed on the system at the
4498 same time.
4499 </p>
4502 If one package is to be installed, the other must be removed
4503 first - if the package being installed is marked as
4504 replacing (see <ref id="replaces">) the one on the system,
4505 or the one on the system is marked as deselected, or both
4506 packages are marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then
4507 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will automatically remove the package
4508 which is causing the conflict, otherwise it will halt the
4509 installation of the new package with an error. This
4510 mechanism is specifically designed to produce an error when
4511 the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the new
4512 package is not.
4513 </p>
4516 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
4517 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
4518 half-installed.
4519 </p>
4522 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
4523 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
4524 package which they provide (see below): this does not
4525 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
4526 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
4527 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
4528 package providing some feature.
4529 </p>
4532 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry should almost never have an
4533 "earlier than" version clause. This would prevent
4534 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the package
4535 which declared such a conflict until the upgrade or removal
4536 of the conflicted-with package had been completed. Instead,
4537 <tt>Breaks</tt> may be used.
4538 </p>
4539 </sect>
4541 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
4542 </heading>
4545 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
4546 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
4547 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4548 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
4549 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4550 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4551 may mention "virtual packages".
4552 </p>
4555 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
4556 <tt>Provides</tt> control file field of another package.
4557 The effect is as if the package(s) which provide a
4558 particular virtual package name had been listed by name
4559 everywhere the virtual package name appears. (See also <ref
4560 id="virtual_pkg">)
4561 </p>
4564 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
4565 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
4566 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
4567 question or any other concrete package which provides the
4568 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
4569 for example, supposing we have
4570 <example compact="compact">
4571 Package: foo
4572 Depends: bar
4573 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
4574 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
4575 <example compact="compact">
4576 Package: bar-plus
4577 Provides: bar
4578 </example>
4579 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
4580 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
4581 </p>
4584 If a relationship field has a version number attached
4585 then only real packages will be considered to see whether
4586 the relationship is satisfied (or the prohibition violated,
4587 for a conflict or breakage) - it is assumed that a real
4588 package which provides the virtual package is not of the
4589 "right" version. So, a <tt>Provides</tt> field may not
4590 contain version numbers, and the version number of the
4591 concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
4592 will not be looked at when considering a dependency on or
4593 conflict with the virtual package name.
4594 </p>
4597 It is likely that the ability will be added in a future
4598 release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to specify a version number for
4599 each virtual package it provides. This feature is not yet
4600 present, however, and is expected to be used only
4601 infrequently.
4602 </p>
4605 If you want to specify which of a set of real packages
4606 should be the default to satisfy a particular dependency on
4607 a virtual package, you should list the real package as an
4608 alternative before the virtual one.
4609 </p>
4610 </sect>
4613 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
4614 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
4617 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
4618 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely
4619 replace other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control file
4620 field has these two distinct purposes.
4621 </p>
4623 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
4626 Firstly, as mentioned before, it is usually an error for a
4627 package to contain files which are on the system in
4628 another package.
4629 </p>
4632 However, if the overwriting package declares that it
4633 <tt>Replaces</tt> the one containing the file being
4634 overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will replace the file
4635 from the old package with that from the new. The file
4636 will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old package.
4637 </p>
4640 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
4641 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
4642 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
4643 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
4644 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
4645 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
4646 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
4647 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
4648 special argument to allow the package to do any final
4649 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
4650 <footnote>
4652 Replaces is a one way relationship -- you have to
4653 install the replacing package after the replaced
4654 package.
4655 </p>
4656 </footnote>
4657 </p>
4660 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
4661 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
4662 <tt>Replaces</tt> field - the packages declared as being
4663 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
4664 </p>
4667 Furthermore, this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes
4668 effect when both packages are at least partially on the
4669 system at once, so that it can only happen if they do not
4670 conflict or if the conflict has been overridden.
4671 </p>
4673 </sect1>
4675 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
4676 removal</heading>
4679 Secondly, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
4680 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
4681 conflict - see <ref id="conflicts">. This usage only
4682 takes effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict,
4683 so that the two usages of this field do not interfere with
4684 each other.
4685 </p>
4688 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
4689 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
4690 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
4691 their control files:
4692 <example compact="compact">
4693 Provides: mail-transport-agent
4694 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
4695 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
4696 </example>
4697 ensuring that only one MTA can be installed at any one
4698 time.
4699 </sect1>
4700 </sect>
4702 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
4703 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
4704 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4705 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4706 </heading>
4709 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
4710 installed or absent at the time of building the package
4711 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
4712 </p>
4715 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
4716 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
4717 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control file fields.
4718 </p>
4721 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
4722 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
4723 </p>
4726 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
4727 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
4728 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
4730 If you make "build-arch" or "binary-arch", you need
4731 Build-Depends. If you make "build-indep" or
4732 "binary-indep", you need Build-Depends and
4733 Build-Depends-Indep. If you make "build" or "binary",
4734 you need both.
4735 </p>
4737 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
4738 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
4739 <tt>build-indep</tt> and binary-indep<tt></tt> targets
4740 is basically assumed to be building the whole package
4741 anyway and so installs all build dependencies. The
4742 autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
4743 calls <tt>build</tt> (not <tt>build-arch</tt>, since it
4744 does not yet know how to check for its existence) and
4745 <tt>binary-arch</tt>.
4746 </p>
4748 The purpose of the original split, I recall, was so that
4749 the autobuilders wouldn't need to install extra packages
4750 needed only for the binary-indep targets. But without a
4751 build-arch/build-indep split, this didn't work, since
4752 most of the work is done in the build target, not in the
4753 binary target.
4754 </p>
4755 </footnote>
4757 <taglist>
4758 <tag><tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt></tag>
4759 <item>
4760 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
4761 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> fields must be satisfied when
4762 any of the following targets is invoked:
4763 <tt>build</tt>, <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
4764 <tt>binary-arch</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>,
4765 <tt>build-indep</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4766 </item>
4767 <tag><tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4768 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt></tag>
4769 <item>
4770 The <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> and
4771 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be
4772 satisfied when any of the following targets is
4773 invoked: <tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>,
4774 <tt>binary</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
4775 </item>
4776 </taglist>
4777 </p>
4779 </sect>
4781 </chapt>
4784 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
4787 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
4788 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
4789 available. This is especially important for packages whose
4790 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
4791 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
4792 </p>
4795 Packages involving shared libraries should be split up into
4796 several binary packages. This section mostly deals with how
4797 this separation is to be accomplished; rules for files within
4798 the shared library packages are in <ref id="libraries"> instead.
4799 </p>
4801 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
4802 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
4805 The run-time shared library needs to be placed in a package
4806 whose name changes whenever the shared object version
4807 changes.<footnote>
4809 Since it is common place to install several versions of a
4810 package that just provides shared libraries, it is a
4811 good idea that the library package should not
4812 contain any extraneous non-versioned files, unless they
4813 happen to be in versioned directories.</p>
4814 </footnote>
4815 The most common mechanism is to place it in a package
4816 called
4817 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
4818 where <file><var>soversion</var></file> is the version number
4819 in the soname of the shared library<footnote>
4820 The soname is the shared object name: it's the thing
4821 that has to match exactly between building an executable
4822 and running it for the dynamic linker to be able run the
4823 program. For example, if the soname of the library is
4824 <file>libfoo.so.6</file>, the library package would be
4825 called <file>libfoo6</file>.
4826 </footnote>.
4827 Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
4828 <var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (e.g. because
4829 <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you may use
4830 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package> and
4831 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var>-dev</package>
4832 instead.
4833 </p>
4836 If you have several shared libraries built from the same
4837 source tree you may lump them all together into a single
4838 shared library package, provided that you change all of
4839 their sonames at once (so that you don't get filename
4840 clashes if you try to install different versions of the
4841 combined shared libraries package).
4842 </p>
4845 The package should install the shared libraries under
4846 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
4847 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
4848 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
4849 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4850 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
4851 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
4852 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
4853 problems.
4854 </p>
4857 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
4858 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
4859 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
4860 </p>
4863 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link that
4864 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for the shared libraries.
4865 For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include
4866 a symbolic link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
4867 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
4868 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
4869 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
4870 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
4871 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4872 script.<footnote>
4873 The package management system requires the library to be
4874 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
4875 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
4876 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
4877 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
4878 version of the library), the new shared library is already
4879 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
4880 library in the temporary packaging directory before
4881 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
4882 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
4883 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
4884 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
4885 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
4886 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
4887 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
4888 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
4889 oneself with the order of file creation.
4890 </footnote>
4891 </p>
4893 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
4894 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
4897 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
4898 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
4899 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
4900 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
4901 These are currently
4902 <list compact="compact">
4903 <item>/usr/local/lib</item>
4904 <item>/usr/lib/libc5-compat</item>
4905 <item>/lib/libc5-compat</item>
4906 </list>
4907 </footnote>
4908 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
4909 system.
4910 </p>
4913 The package maintainer scripts must only call
4914 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
4915 <list compact="compact">
4916 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
4917 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
4918 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
4919 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
4920 </item>
4921 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
4922 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
4923 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
4924 </item>
4925 </list>
4926 <footnote>
4928 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
4929 the new files are installed, so calling "ldconfig" is
4930 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
4931 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
4932 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
4933 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
4934 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
4935 time.
4936 </p>
4939 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
4940 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
4941 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
4942 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
4943 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
4944 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
4945 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
4946 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
4947 point.
4948 </p>
4951 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
4952 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
4953 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
4954 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
4955 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
4956 </p>
4959 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
4960 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
4961 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
4962 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
4963 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
4964 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
4965 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
4966 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
4967 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
4968 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
4969 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
4970 </p>
4971 </footnote>
4972 </p>
4973 </sect1>
4975 </sect>
4977 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
4978 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
4981 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
4982 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
4983 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
4984 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
4985 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
4986 unnecessarily difficult.
4987 </p>
4990 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
4991 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
4992 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
4993 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
4994 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
4995 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
4996 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
4997 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
4998 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
4999 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5000 names change when the shared object version changes.
5001 </p>
5004 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5005 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5006 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5007 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5008 This package might typically be named
5009 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5010 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5011 </p>
5014 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5015 against the library should be included in the development
5016 package for the library.<footnote>
5017 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5018 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5019 </footnote>
5020 </p>
5021 </sect>
5023 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5024 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5027 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5028 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5029 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5030 </p>
5033 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5034 available in static form only; these cases include:
5035 <list>
5036 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5037 is immature or unstable</item>
5038 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5039 development (commonly the case when the library's
5040 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5041 across patchlevels)</item>
5042 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5043 available only in static form by their upstream
5044 author(s)</item>
5045 </list>
5046 </p>
5048 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5049 <heading>Development files</heading>
5052 The development files associated to a shared library need to be
5053 placed in a package called
5054 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5055 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5056 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>.
5057 </p>
5060 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5061 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5062 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5063 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5064 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5065 filename clash if both were installed).
5066 </p>
5069 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5070 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5071 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5072 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5073 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5074 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5075 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5076 </p>
5077 </sect>
5079 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5080 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5083 Typically the development version should have an exact
5084 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5085 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5086 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5087 useful for this purpose.
5088 <footnote>
5089 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5090 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5091 </footnote>
5092 </p>
5093 </sect>
5095 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5096 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5097 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5100 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5101 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5102 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5103 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5104 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5105 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5106 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5107 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5108 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5109 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5110 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5111 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5112 </p>
5115 Thus, when a package is built which contains any shared
5116 libraries, it must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other
5117 packages to use, and when a package is built which contains
5118 any shared libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5119 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5120 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5121 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5123 In the past, the shared libraries linked to were
5124 determined by calling <prgn>ldd</prgn>, but now
5125 <prgn>objdump</prgn> is used to do this. The only
5126 change this makes to package building is that
5127 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must also be run on shared
5128 libraries, whereas in the past this was unnecessary.
5129 The rest of this footnote explains the advantage that
5130 this method gives.
5131 </p>
5134 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5135 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5136 with that library (that is, it uses the flag
5137 <tt>-lbar</tt> during the linking stage). Other
5138 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5139 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5140 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5141 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on
5142 the libraries it directly uses, and the dependencies for
5143 those libraries should automatically pull in the other
5144 libraries.
5145 </p>
5148 Unfortunately, the <prgn>ldd</prgn> program shows both
5149 the directly and indirectly used libraries, meaning that
5150 the dependencies determined included both direct and
5151 indirect dependencies. The use of <prgn>objdump</prgn>
5152 avoids this problem by determining only the directly
5153 used libraries.
5154 </p>
5157 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5158 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5159 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining
5160 the same major version number). If we used the old
5161 <prgn>ldd</prgn> method, every package that uses
5162 <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so it
5163 would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it wouldn't run
5164 due to missing symbols. However with the new system,
5165 packages using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on
5166 <tt>libimlib</tt> itself having the dependency on
5167 <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would not need rebuilding.
5168 </p>
5169 </footnote>
5170 </p>
5173 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5174 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5175 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5176 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5177 shared library.
5178 </p>
5180 <sect1>
5181 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5184 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5185 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5186 they are read by
5187 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5188 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5189 </p>
5192 <list>
5193 <item>
5194 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5197 This lists overrides for this package. Its use is
5198 described below (see <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5199 </p>
5200 </item>
5202 <item>
5203 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5206 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5207 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5208 administrator.
5209 </p>
5210 </item>
5212 <item>
5213 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5216 When packages are being built, any
5217 <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5218 control file area of the temporary build directory and
5219 given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These files give
5220 details of any shared libraries included in the
5221 package.<footnote>
5222 An example may help here. Let us say that the
5223 source package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5224 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and
5225 <tt>foo-runtime</tt>. When building the binary
5226 packages, the two packages are created in the
5227 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file> and
5228 <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5229 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one
5230 of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5231 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5232 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5233 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually
5234 to become
5235 <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>. Then
5236 when <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5237 executable
5238 <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>, it
5239 will examine the
5240 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5241 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5242 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5243 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5244 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once
5245 all of the individual binary packages'
5246 <tt>shlibs</tt> files have been installed into the
5247 build directory.
5248 </footnote>
5249 </p>
5250 </item>
5252 <item>
5253 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5256 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5257 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5258 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5259 </p>
5260 </item>
5262 <item>
5263 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5266 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5267 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5268 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5269 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5270 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5271 </p>
5272 </item>
5273 </list>
5274 </p>
5275 </sect1>
5277 <sect1>
5278 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5279 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5282 Put a call to
5283 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5284 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5285 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5286 you can use a command such as:
5287 <example compact="compact">
5288 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5289 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5290 </example>
5291 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5292 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5293 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5294 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
5295 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary
5296 packages.
5297 </footnote>
5298 </p>
5301 This command puts the dependency information into the
5302 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5303 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5304 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5305 field in the control file for this to work.
5306 </p>
5309 If <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> doesn't complain, you're
5310 done. If it does complain you might need to create your own
5311 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file, as explained below (see
5312 <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5313 </p>
5316 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5317 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5318 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5319 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5320 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5321 </p>
5324 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer, you
5325 will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> should use
5326 the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by adding
5327 <tt>-tudeb</tt> as option<footnote>
5328 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
5329 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
5330 processing a udeb.
5331 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt>
5332 in the <file>shlibs</file> file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will
5333 fall back to the regular dependency line.
5334 </p>
5337 For more details on dpkg-shlibdeps, please see
5338 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
5339 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
5340 </p>
5341 </sect1>
5343 <sect1 id="shlibs">
5344 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
5347 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
5348 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
5349 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
5350 <example compact="compact">
5351 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
5352 </example>
5353 </p>
5356 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
5357 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
5358 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
5359 </p>
5362 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
5363 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
5364 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
5365 required.
5366 </p>
5369 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
5370 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
5371 of the soname, see below.)
5372 </p>
5375 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
5376 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
5377 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
5378 usually of the form
5379 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
5380 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
5381 This can be determined using the command
5382 <example compact="compact">
5383 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
5384 </example>
5385 </footnote>
5386 The version part is the part which comes after
5387 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>.
5388 </p>
5391 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
5392 field in a binary package control file. It should give
5393 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
5394 built against the version of the library contained in the
5395 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
5396 </p>
5399 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
5400 package which contained a minor number of at least
5401 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
5402 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
5403 <example compact="compact">
5404 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
5405 </example>
5406 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
5407 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
5408 newer binaries.
5409 </p>
5412 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
5413 there would also be a second line:
5414 <example compact="compact">
5415 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
5416 </example>
5417 </p>
5418 </sect1>
5420 <sect1>
5421 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
5424 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
5425 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
5426 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
5427 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
5428 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
5429 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control area:
5430 <example compact="compact">
5431 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
5432 </example>
5433 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
5434 <example compact="compact">
5435 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
5436 </example>
5437 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
5438 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control area directly from
5439 <file>debian/rules</file> without using a <file>debian/shlibs</file>
5440 file at all,<footnote>
5441 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in the
5442 <tt>debhelper</tt> suite does. If your package also has a udeb
5443 that provides a shared library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can
5444 automatically generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify
5445 the name of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
5446 </footnote>
5447 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
5448 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
5449 </p>
5452 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
5453 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
5454 being built from this source package, all of the
5455 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
5456 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
5457 packages.
5458 </p>
5459 </sect1>
5461 <sect1 id="shlibslocal">
5462 <heading>Writing the <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file</heading>
5465 This file is intended only as a <em>temporary</em> fix if
5466 your binaries or libraries depend on a library whose package
5467 does not yet provide a correct <file>shlibs</file> file.
5468 </p>
5471 We will assume that you are trying to package a binary
5472 <tt>foo</tt>. When you try running
5473 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> you get the following error
5474 message (<tt>-O</tt> displays the dependency information on
5475 <tt>stdout</tt> instead of writing it to
5476 <tt>debian/substvars</tt>, and the lines have been wrapped
5477 for ease of reading):
5478 <example compact="compact">
5479 $ dpkg-shlibdeps -O debian/tmp/usr/bin/foo
5480 dpkg-shlibdeps: warning: unable to find dependency
5481 information for shared library libbar (soname 1,
5482 path /usr/lib/libbar.so.1, dependency field Depends)
5483 shlibs:Depends=libc6 (>= 2.2.2-2)
5484 </example>
5485 You can then run <prgn>ldd</prgn> on the binary to find the
5486 full location of the library concerned:
5487 <example compact="compact">
5488 $ ldd foo
5489 libbar.so.1 => /usr/lib/libbar.so.1 (0x4001e000)
5490 libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40032000)
5491 /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000)
5492 </example>
5493 So the <prgn>foo</prgn> binary depends on the
5494 <prgn>libbar</prgn> shared library, but no package seems to
5495 provide a <file>*.shlibs</file> file handling
5496 <file>libbar.so.1</file> in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/</file>. Let's
5497 determine the package responsible:
5498 <example compact="compact">
5499 $ dpkg -S /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5500 bar1: /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5501 $ dpkg -s bar1 | grep Version
5502 Version: 1.0-1
5503 </example>
5504 This tells us that the <tt>bar1</tt> package, version 1.0-1,
5505 is the one we are using. Now we can file a bug against the
5506 <tt>bar1</tt> package and create our own
5507 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> to locally fix the problem.
5508 Including the following line into your
5509 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file:
5510 <example compact="compact">
5511 libbar 1 bar1 (>= 1.0-1)
5512 </example>
5513 should allow the package build to work.
5514 </p>
5517 As soon as the maintainer of <tt>bar1</tt> provides a
5518 correct <file>shlibs</file> file, you should remove this line
5519 from your <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file. (You should
5520 probably also then have a versioned <tt>Build-Depends</tt>
5521 on <tt>bar1</tt> to help ensure that others do not have the
5522 same problem building your package.)
5523 </p>
5524 </sect1>
5526 </sect>
5528 </chapt>
5531 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
5533 <sect>
5534 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
5537 <sect1 id="fhs">
5538 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
5541 The location of all installed files and directories must
5542 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
5543 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
5544 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
5545 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
5547 <enumlist>
5548 <item>
5550 The optional rules related to user specific
5551 configuration files for applications are stored in
5552 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
5553 recommended that such files start with the
5554 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
5555 application needs to create more than one dot file
5556 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
5557 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
5558 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
5559 configuration files not start with the '.'
5560 character.
5561 </p>
5562 </item>
5563 <item>
5565 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
5566 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
5567 </p>
5568 </item>
5569 <item>
5571 The requirement that
5572 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
5573 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
5574 recommendation</p>
5575 </item>
5576 <item>
5578 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
5579 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
5580 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
5581 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
5582 window manager name itself.
5583 </p>
5584 </item>
5585 <item>
5587 The requirement that boot manager configuration
5588 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
5589 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
5590 </p>
5591 </item>
5592 </enumlist>
5594 </p>
5596 The version of this document referred here can be
5597 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
5598 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
5599 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
5600 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
5601 you can try <url
5602 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
5603 (local copy)">). The
5604 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
5605 be found on
5606 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
5607 Specific questions about following the standard may be
5608 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
5609 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
5610 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
5611 more information).
5612 </p>
5613 </sect1>
5615 <sect1>
5616 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
5619 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
5620 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
5621 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5622 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
5623 </p>
5626 However, the package may create empty directories below
5627 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
5628 where to place site-specific files. These are not
5629 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
5630 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
5631 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
5632 should be removed on package removal if they are
5633 empty.
5634 </p>
5637 Note, that this applies only to directories <em>below</em>
5638 <file>/usr/local</file>, not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>.
5639 Packages must not create sub-directories in the directory
5640 <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those listed in FHS,
5641 section 4.5. However, you may create directories below
5642 them as you wish. You must not remove any of the
5643 directories listed in 4.5, even if you created them.
5644 </p>
5647 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
5648 remote server, these directories must be created and
5649 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
5650 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
5651 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
5652 either of these operations fail.
5653 </p>
5656 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
5657 contain something like
5658 <example compact="compact">
5659 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
5660 then
5661 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
5662 then
5663 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
5664 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
5667 </example>
5668 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
5669 <example compact="compact">
5670 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
5671 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
5672 </example>
5673 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
5674 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
5675 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
5676 removed.)
5677 </p>
5680 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
5681 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
5682 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
5683 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
5684 </p>
5687 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
5688 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
5689 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
5690 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
5691 </p>
5694 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
5695 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
5696 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
5697 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
5698 </p>
5699 </sect1>
5701 <sect1>
5702 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
5704 The system-wide mail directory is <file>/var/mail</file>. This
5705 directory is part of the base system and should not owned
5706 by any particular mail agents. The use of the old
5707 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
5708 though the spool may still be physically located there.
5709 </p>
5710 </sect1>
5711 </sect>
5713 <sect>
5714 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
5716 <sect1>
5717 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5719 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
5720 shadow passwords.
5721 </p>
5724 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
5725 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
5726 packages need to include files which are owned by these
5727 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
5728 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
5729 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
5730 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
5731 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
5732 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
5733 </p>
5736 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
5737 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
5738 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
5739 </p>
5742 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
5743 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
5744 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
5745 </p>
5746 </sect1>
5748 <sect1>
5749 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
5751 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
5752 follows:
5753 <taglist>
5754 <tag>0-99:</tag>
5755 <item>
5757 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
5758 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
5759 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
5760 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
5761 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
5762 updated.
5763 </p>
5766 Packages which need a single statically allocated
5767 uid or gid should use one of these; their
5768 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
5769 maintainer for ids.
5770 </p>
5771 </item>
5773 <tag>100-999:</tag>
5774 <item>
5776 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
5777 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
5778 this user or group allocated dynamically and
5779 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
5780 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
5781 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
5782 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
5783 id based on the ranges specified in
5784 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
5785 </p>
5786 </item>
5788 <tag>1000-29999:</tag>
5789 <item>
5791 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
5792 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
5793 user accounts in this range, though
5794 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
5795 behavior.
5796 </p>
5797 </item>
5799 <tag>30000-59999:</tag>
5800 <item>
5801 <p>Reserved.</p>
5802 </item>
5804 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
5805 <item>
5807 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
5808 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
5809 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
5810 created on users' systems on demand.
5811 </p>
5814 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
5815 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
5816 packages should check for and create the accounts in
5817 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
5818 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
5819 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
5820 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
5821 them in the allocation, to give them room to
5822 grow.
5823 </p>
5824 </item>
5826 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
5827 <item>
5828 <p>Reserved.</p>
5829 </item>
5831 <tag>65534:</tag>
5832 <item>
5834 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
5835 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
5836 </p>
5837 </item>
5839 <tag>65535:</tag>
5840 <item>
5842 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
5843 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
5844 sentinel value.
5845 </p>
5846 </item>
5847 </taglist>
5848 </p>
5849 </sect1>
5850 </sect>
5852 <sect id="sysvinit">
5853 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
5855 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
5856 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5859 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
5860 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
5861 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
5862 name="init" section="8">).
5863 </p>
5866 There are at least two different, yet functionally
5867 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
5868 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
5869 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
5870 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
5871 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
5872 maintainer scripts must be performed using
5873 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
5874 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
5875 on the implementation details of the other method,
5876 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
5877 to the documentation of that package.
5878 </p>
5881 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
5882 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
5883 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
5884 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
5885 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
5886 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
5887 scripts.
5888 </p>
5891 The names of the links all have the form
5892 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
5893 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
5894 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
5895 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
5896 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
5897 </p>
5900 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
5901 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
5902 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
5903 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
5904 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
5905 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
5906 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
5907 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
5908 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
5909 </p>
5912 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
5913 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
5914 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
5915 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
5916 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
5917 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
5918 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
5919 of <tt>start</tt>.
5920 </p>
5923 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
5924 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
5925 have their scripts run first. For example, the
5926 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
5927 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
5928 must be started before another. For example, the name
5929 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
5930 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
5931 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
5932 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
5933 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
5934 runs first:
5935 <example compact="compact">
5936 /etc/rc2.d/S17bind
5937 /etc/rc2.d/S70inn
5938 </example>
5939 </p>
5942 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
5943 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
5944 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
5945 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
5946 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
5947 </p>
5948 </sect1>
5950 <sect1>
5951 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
5954 Packages that include daemons for system services should
5955 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
5956 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
5957 These scripts should be named
5958 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
5959 accept one argument, saying what to do:
5961 <taglist>
5962 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
5963 <item>start the service,</item>
5965 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
5966 <item>stop the service,</item>
5968 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
5969 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
5970 otherwise start the service</item>
5972 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
5973 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
5974 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
5975 the service,</item>
5977 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
5978 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
5979 service supports this, otherwise restart the
5980 service.</item>
5981 </taglist>
5983 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
5984 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
5985 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
5986 option is optional.
5987 </p>
5990 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
5991 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
5992 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
5993 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
5994 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
5995 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
5996 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
5997 option.
5998 </p>
6001 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6002 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6003 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6004 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6005 successfully.
6006 </p>
6009 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6010 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6011 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6012 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6013 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6014 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6015 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6016 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6017 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6018 some special command line options when starting a service,
6019 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6020 package upgrade.
6021 </p>
6024 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6025 configuration files remain but the package has been
6026 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6027 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6028 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6029 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6030 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6031 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6032 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6033 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6034 script, like this:
6035 <example compact="compact">
6036 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6037 </example>
6038 </p>
6041 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6042 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6043 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6044 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6045 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6046 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6047 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6048 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6049 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6050 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6051 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6052 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6053 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6054 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6055 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6056 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6057 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6058 for more details.
6059 </p>
6062 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6063 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6064 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6065 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6066 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6067 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6068 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6069 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6070 </p>
6073 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6074 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6075 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6076 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6077 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6078 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6079 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6080 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6081 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6082 </p>
6083 </sect1>
6085 <sect1>
6086 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6089 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6090 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6091 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6092 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6093 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6094 </p>
6097 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6098 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6099 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6100 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6101 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6102 </p>
6104 <sect2>
6105 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6108 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6109 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6110 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6111 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6112 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6113 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6114 </p>
6117 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6118 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6119 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6120 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6121 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6122 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6123 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6124 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6125 package may do so.)
6126 </p>
6129 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6130 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6131 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6132 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6133 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6134 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6135 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6136 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6137 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6138 is being used.
6139 </p>
6142 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6143 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6144 <example compact="compact">
6145 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6146 </example>
6147 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6148 <example compact="compact">
6149 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6150 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6152 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6153 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6154 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6155 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6156 </p>
6159 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6160 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6161 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6162 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6163 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6164 help you choose a number.
6165 </p>
6168 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6169 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6170 section="8">.
6171 </p>
6172 </sect2>
6174 <sect2>
6175 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6177 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6178 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6179 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6180 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6181 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6182 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6183 </p>
6186 The package maintainer scripts must use
6187 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6188 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6189 calling them directly.
6190 </p>
6193 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6194 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6195 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6196 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6197 runlevels.
6198 </p>
6201 Most packages will simply need to change:
6202 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/&lt;package&gt;
6203 &lt;action&gt;</example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6204 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6205 <example compact="compact">
6206 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6207 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6208 else
6209 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> &lt;action&gt;
6211 </example>
6212 </p>
6215 A package should register its initscript services using
6216 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6217 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6218 unregistered services may fail.
6219 </p>
6222 For more information about using
6223 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6224 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6225 </p>
6226 </sect2>
6227 </sect1>
6229 <sect1>
6230 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6233 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6234 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6235 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6236 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6237 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6238 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6239 </p>
6240 </sect1>
6242 <sect1>
6243 <heading>Example</heading>
6246 An example on which you can base your
6247 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6248 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6249 </p>
6251 </sect1>
6252 </sect>
6254 <sect>
6255 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6258 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6259 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6260 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6261 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6262 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6263 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6264 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6265 </p>
6268 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6269 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6270 </p>
6273 <list>
6274 <item>
6275 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6276 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6277 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6278 </item>
6280 <item>
6281 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6282 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6283 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6284 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6285 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6286 </item>
6288 <item>
6289 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6290 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6291 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6292 <example compact="compact">
6293 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6294 </example>
6295 the message should say
6296 <example compact="compact">
6297 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6298 </example>
6299 </item>
6300 </list>
6301 </p>
6304 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6305 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6306 </p>
6309 <list>
6310 <item>
6311 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6314 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6315 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6316 spaces):
6317 <example compact="compact">
6318 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
6319 </example>
6320 The <var>description</var> should describe the
6321 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
6322 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
6323 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
6324 the program).
6325 </p>
6328 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
6329 would look like:
6330 <example compact="compact">
6331 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
6332 </example>
6333 </p>
6336 This can be achieved by saying
6337 <example compact="compact">
6338 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
6339 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
6340 echo "."
6341 </example>
6342 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
6343 start, the output should look like this:
6344 <example compact="compact">
6345 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
6346 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
6347 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
6348 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
6349 echo "."
6350 </example>
6351 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
6352 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
6353 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
6354 in the example above the system administrators can
6355 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
6356 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
6357 looks good.
6358 </p>
6359 </item>
6361 <item>
6362 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
6365 If you have to set up different system parameters
6366 during the system boot, you should use this format:
6367 <example compact="compact">
6368 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
6369 </example>
6370 </p>
6373 You can use a statement such as the following to get
6374 the quotes right:
6375 <example compact="compact">
6376 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
6377 </example>
6378 </p>
6381 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) is used for the left
6382 and right quotation marks. A grave accent (<tt>`</tt>) is
6383 not a quote character; neither is an apostrophe
6384 (<tt>'</tt>).
6385 </p>
6386 </item>
6388 <item>
6389 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
6392 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
6393 message identical to the startup message, except that
6394 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
6395 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
6396 </p>
6399 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
6400 this:
6401 <example compact="compact">
6402 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
6403 </example>
6404 </p>
6405 </item>
6407 <item>
6408 <p>When something is executed</p>
6411 There are several examples where you have to run a
6412 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
6413 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
6414 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
6415 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
6416 like this:
6417 <example compact="compact">
6418 Doing something very useful...done.
6419 </example>
6420 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
6421 the job has been completed, so that the user is
6422 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
6423 behavior by saying
6424 <example compact="compact">
6425 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
6426 do_something
6427 echo "done."
6428 </example>
6429 in your script.
6430 </p>
6431 </item>
6433 <item>
6434 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
6437 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
6438 files you should use the following format:
6439 <example compact="compact">
6440 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
6441 </example>
6442 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
6443 daemon starting message.
6444 </p>
6445 </item>
6446 </list>
6447 </p>
6448 </sect>
6450 <sect>
6451 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
6454 Packages must not modify the configuration file
6455 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
6456 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
6459 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
6460 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
6461 package in one or more of the following directories:
6462 <example compact="compact">
6463 /etc/cron.hourly
6464 /etc/cron.daily
6465 /etc/cron.weekly
6466 /etc/cron.monthly
6467 </example>
6468 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
6469 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
6470 respectively. The exact times are listed in
6471 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
6474 All files installed in any of these directories must be
6475 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
6476 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
6477 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
6478 </p>
6481 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
6482 at a specific time, the package should install a file
6483 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
6484 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
6485 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
6486 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
6487 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
6488 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
6489 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
6490 running.)</p>
6493 The scripts or crontab entries in these directories should
6494 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
6495 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
6496 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
6497 are kept on the system in this situation.</p>
6498 </sect>
6500 <sect id="menus">
6501 <heading>Menus</heading>
6504 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
6505 interface between packages providing applications and
6506 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
6507 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
6508 </p>
6511 All packages that provide applications that need not be
6512 passed any special command line arguments for normal
6513 operation should register a menu entry for those
6514 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
6515 will automatically get menu entries in their window
6516 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
6517 </p>
6520 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
6521 </p>
6524 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
6525 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6526 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6527 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
6528 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
6529 </p>
6532 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
6533 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
6534 package for information about how to register your
6535 applications.
6536 </p>
6537 </sect>
6539 <sect id="mime">
6540 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
6543 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
6544 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
6545 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
6546 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
6547 MP3).
6548 </p>
6551 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
6552 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
6553 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
6554 </p>
6557 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
6558 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
6559 as such following the current MIME support policy.
6560 </p>
6563 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
6564 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6565 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6566 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
6567 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
6568 </p>
6570 </sect>
6572 <sect>
6573 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
6576 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
6577 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
6578 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
6579 comply with the following guidelines.
6580 </p>
6583 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
6585 <taglist>
6586 <tag><tt>&lt;--</tt></tag>
6587 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
6589 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
6590 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
6592 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
6593 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
6594 </taglist>
6596 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
6597 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
6598 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
6599 etc.
6600 </p>
6603 The following list explains how the different programs
6604 should be set up to achieve this:
6605 </p>
6608 <list>
6609 <item>
6610 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
6611 </item>
6613 <item>
6614 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
6615 </item>
6617 <item>
6618 X translations are set up to make
6619 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
6620 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
6621 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
6622 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
6623 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
6624 using the application defaults, so that the
6625 translation resources used correspond to the
6626 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
6627 </item>
6629 <item>
6630 The Linux console is configured to make
6631 <tt>&lt;--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
6632 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
6633 </item>
6635 <item>
6636 X applications are configured so that <tt>&lt;</tt>
6637 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
6638 applications already work like this.
6639 </item>
6641 <item>
6642 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
6643 </item>
6645 <item>
6646 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
6647 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
6648 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
6649 </item>
6651 <item>
6652 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
6653 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
6654 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
6655 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
6656 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
6657 </item>
6659 <item>
6660 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6661 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
6662 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
6663 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
6664 cursor".
6665 </item>
6667 </list>
6668 </p>
6671 This will solve the problem except for the following
6672 cases:
6673 </p>
6676 <list>
6677 <item>
6678 Some terminals have a <tt>&lt;--</tt> key that cannot
6679 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
6680 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
6681 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6682 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
6683 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
6684 available) can be used instead.
6685 </item>
6687 <item>
6688 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
6689 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
6690 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
6691 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
6692 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
6693 correctly, things can be made to work by using
6694 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
6695 </item>
6697 <item>
6698 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
6699 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
6700 <tt>&lt;--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
6701 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
6702 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
6703 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
6704 using their resources when things are the other way
6705 around. On displays configured like this
6706 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt>&lt;--</tt>
6707 will.
6708 </item>
6710 <item>
6711 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
6712 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
6713 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
6714 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
6715 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
6716 <tt>&lt;--</tt> will.
6717 </item>
6718 </list>
6719 </p>
6720 </sect>
6722 <sect>
6723 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
6726 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
6727 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
6728 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
6729 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
6730 supported by all shells.)
6731 </p>
6734 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
6735 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
6736 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
6737 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
6738 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
6739 available), the program must be replaced by a small
6740 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
6741 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
6742 </p>
6745 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
6747 <example compact="compact">
6748 #!/bin/sh
6749 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
6750 export BAR
6751 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
6752 </example>
6753 </p>
6756 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
6757 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
6758 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
6759 file.
6760 </p>
6761 </sect>
6763 <sect id="doc-base">
6764 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
6767 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
6768 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
6769 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
6770 package that provides online documentation (other than just
6771 manual pages) to register these documents with
6772 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
6773 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
6774 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
6775 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
6776 </p>
6778 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
6779 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
6780 details.
6781 </p>
6782 </sect>
6784 </chapt>
6787 <chapt id="files">
6788 <heading>Files</heading>
6790 <sect>
6791 <heading>Binaries</heading>
6794 Two different packages must not install programs with
6795 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
6796 case of two programs having the same functionality but
6797 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
6798 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
6799 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
6800 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
6801 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
6802 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
6803 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
6804 programs must be renamed.
6805 </p>
6808 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
6809 created should include debugging information, as well as
6810 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
6811 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
6812 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
6813 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
6814 this means the following compilation parameters should be
6815 used:
6816 <example compact="compact">
6817 CC = gcc
6818 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
6819 LDFLAGS = # none
6820 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
6821 </example>
6822 </p>
6825 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
6826 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
6827 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
6828 the binaries after they have been copied into
6829 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
6830 package.
6831 </p>
6834 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
6835 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
6836 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
6837 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
6838 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
6839 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
6840 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
6841 </p>
6844 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
6845 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
6846 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
6847 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
6848 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
6849 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
6850 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
6851 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
6852 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
6853 environment.
6854 </p>
6855 </sect>
6858 <sect id="libraries">
6859 <heading>Libraries</heading>
6862 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
6863 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
6864 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
6865 the supported architectures<footnote>
6867 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
6868 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
6869 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
6870 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
6871 permitted in a shared library.
6872 </p>
6874 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
6875 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
6876 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
6877 the few architectures where non position independent code is
6878 even possible.
6879 </p>
6880 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
6881 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
6882 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
6883 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
6884 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
6885 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
6886 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
6888 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
6889 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
6890 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
6891 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
6892 </p>
6893 </footnote>
6894 </p>
6896 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
6897 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
6898 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
6899 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
6900 should be discussed on the mailing list
6901 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
6902 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
6903 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
6905 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
6906 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
6907 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
6908 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
6909 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
6910 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
6911 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
6912 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
6913 distilling various libraries into a common shared
6914 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
6915 installer project.
6916 </p>
6917 </footnote>
6918 </p>
6920 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
6921 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
6922 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
6923 case.
6924 </p>
6926 You must specify the gcc option <tt>-D_REENTRANT</tt>
6927 when building a library (either static or shared) to make
6928 the library compatible with LinuxThreads.
6929 </p>
6932 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
6933 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
6934 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
6935 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
6936 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
6937 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
6938 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
6939 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
6940 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
6941 build error.
6942 </p>
6945 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
6946 <example compact="compact">
6947 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
6948 </example>
6949 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
6950 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
6951 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
6952 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
6953 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
6954 file.<footnote>
6955 You might also want to use the options
6956 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
6957 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
6958 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
6959 libraries.
6960 </footnote>
6961 </p>
6964 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
6965 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
6966 building a separate package to support debugging.
6967 </p>
6970 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
6971 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
6972 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
6973 should be installed in subdirectories of the
6974 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
6975 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
6976 they must not be installed executable and should be
6977 stripped.<footnote>
6978 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
6979 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
6980 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
6981 </footnote>
6982 </p>
6985 An ever increasing number of packages are using
6986 <prgn>libtool</prgn> to do their linking. The latest GNU
6987 libtools (>= 1.3a) can take advantage of the metadata in the
6988 installed <prgn>libtool</prgn> archive files (<file>*.la</file>
6989 files). The main advantage of <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s
6990 <file>.la</file> files is that it allows <prgn>libtool</prgn> to
6991 store and subsequently access metadata with respect to the
6992 libraries it builds. <prgn>libtool</prgn> will search for
6993 those files, which contain a lot of useful information about
6994 a library (such as library dependency information for static
6995 linking). Also, they're <em>essential</em> for programs
6996 using <tt>libltdl</tt>.<footnote>
6997 Although <prgn>libtool</prgn> is fully capable of
6998 linking against shared libraries which don't have
6999 <tt>.la</tt> files, as it is a mere shell script it can
7000 add considerably to the build time of a
7001 <prgn>libtool</prgn>-using package if that shell script
7002 has to derive all this information from first principles
7003 for each library every time it is linked. With the
7004 advent of <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.4 (and to a
7005 lesser extent <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.3), the
7006 <file>.la</file> files also store information about
7007 inter-library dependencies which cannot necessarily be
7008 derived after the <file>.la</file> file is deleted.
7009 </footnote>
7010 </p>
7013 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create shared
7014 libraries should include the <file>.la</file> files in the
7015 <tt>-dev</tt> package, unless the package relies on
7016 <tt>libtool</tt>'s <tt>libltdl</tt> library, in which case
7017 the <tt>.la</tt> files must go in the run-time library
7018 package.
7019 </p>
7022 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7023 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7024 users will not be able to run your binaries
7025 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7026 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7027 idea.
7028 </p>
7029 </sect>
7032 <sect>
7033 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7035 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7036 </p>
7037 </sect>
7040 <sect id="scripts">
7041 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7044 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7045 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7046 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7047 to interpret them.
7048 </p>
7051 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7052 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7053 </p>
7056 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7057 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7058 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7059 language currently used to implement it.
7060 </p>
7062 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>)
7063 should almost certainly start with <tt>set -e</tt> so that
7064 errors are detected. Every script should use
7065 <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status of <em>every</em>
7066 command.
7067 </p>
7070 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7071 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7072 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7073 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7074 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7075 name="The Open Group"> after free
7076 registration.</footnote>
7077 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7078 SUSv3:<footnote>
7079 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7080 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7081 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7082 </footnote>
7083 <list>
7084 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7085 must not generate a newline.</item>
7086 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7087 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7088 operators.</item>
7089 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7090 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7091 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7092 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7093 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7094 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7095 <example compact>
7096 fname () {
7097 local a b c=delta d
7098 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7100 </example>
7101 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7102 <tt>delta</tt>.
7103 </item>
7104 </list>
7105 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7106 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7107 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7108 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7109 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7110 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7111 </p>
7114 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7115 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7116 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7117 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7118 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7119 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7120 </p>
7123 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7124 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7125 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7126 </p>
7129 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7130 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7131 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7132 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7133 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7134 then you must make sure that they start with
7135 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7136 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7137 </p>
7140 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7141 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7142 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7143 name already exists.
7144 </p>
7147 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7148 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7149 this purpose.
7150 </p>
7151 </sect>
7154 <sect>
7155 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7158 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7159 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7160 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7161 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7162 directory <file>/</file>.)
7163 </p>
7166 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7167 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7168 deprecated.
7169 </p>
7172 Note that when creating a relative link using
7173 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7174 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7175 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7176 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7177 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7178 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7179 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7180 to <prgn>ln</prgn>.
7181 </p>
7184 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7185 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7186 <example compact="compact">
7187 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7188 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7189 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7190 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7191 </example>
7192 </p>
7195 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7196 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7197 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7198 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7199 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7200 </p>
7201 </sect>
7203 <sect>
7204 <heading>Device files</heading>
7207 Packages must not include device files in the package file
7208 tree.
7209 </p>
7212 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7213 included in the base system, it must call
7214 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7215 after notifying the user<footnote>
7216 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7217 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7218 </footnote>.
7219 </p>
7222 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7223 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7224 system administrator.
7225 </p>
7228 Debian uses the serial devices
7229 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7230 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7231 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7232 </p>
7233 </sect>
7235 <sect id="config-files">
7236 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
7238 <sect1>
7239 <heading>Definitions</heading>
7242 <taglist>
7243 <tag>configuration file</tag>
7244 <item>
7245 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
7246 provides site- or host-specific information, or
7247 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
7248 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
7249 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
7250 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
7251 more useful site-specific behavior.
7252 </item>
7254 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
7255 <item>
7256 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
7257 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7258 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
7259 </item>
7260 </taglist>
7261 </p>
7264 The distinction between these two is important; they are
7265 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
7266 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
7267 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
7268 </p>
7271 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
7272 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
7273 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
7274 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
7275 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
7276 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
7277 file and should be treated as such.
7278 </p>
7279 </sect1>
7281 <sect1>
7282 <heading>Location</heading>
7285 Any configuration files created or used by your package
7286 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
7287 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
7288 named after your package.
7289 </p>
7292 If your package creates or uses configuration files
7293 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
7294 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
7295 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
7296 from the location that the package requires.
7297 </p>
7298 </sect1>
7300 <sect1>
7301 <heading>Behavior</heading>
7304 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
7305 behavior:
7306 <list compact="compact">
7307 <item>
7308 local changes must be preserved during a package
7309 upgrade, and
7310 </item>
7311 <item>
7312 configuration files must be preserved when the
7313 package is removed, and only deleted when the
7314 package is purged.
7315 </item>
7316 </list>
7317 </p>
7320 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
7321 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
7322 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
7323 version that will work for most installations, although
7324 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
7325 implies that the default version will be part of the
7326 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
7327 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
7328 time).
7329 </p>
7332 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
7333 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
7334 conffiles.<footnote>
7335 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
7336 The first is that some editors break the link while
7337 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
7338 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
7339 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
7340 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
7341 </footnote>
7342 </p>
7345 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
7346 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
7347 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
7348 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
7349 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
7350 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
7351 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
7352 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
7353 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
7354 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
7355 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
7356 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
7357 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
7358 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
7359 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
7360 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
7361 otherwise be good citizens.
7362 </p>
7365 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
7366 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
7367 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
7368 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
7369 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
7370 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
7371 </p>
7374 A common practice is to create a script called
7375 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
7376 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
7377 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
7378 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
7379 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
7380 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
7381 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
7382 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
7383 be symbolic links to them from
7384 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
7385 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
7386 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
7387 configuration files).
7388 </p>
7391 These two styles of configuration file handling must
7392 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
7393 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
7394 every time the package is upgraded.
7395 </p>
7396 </sect1>
7398 <sect1>
7399 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
7402 Packages which specify the same file as a
7403 <tt>conffile</tt> must be tagged as <em>conflicting</em>
7404 with each other. (This is an instance of the general rule
7405 about not sharing files. Note that neither alternatives
7406 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case;
7407 in particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
7408 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.)
7409 </p>
7412 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
7413 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
7414 belong to.
7415 </p>
7418 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
7419 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
7420 time, one of these packages must be defined as
7421 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
7422 the package which handles that file as a configuration
7423 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
7424 depend on the owning package if they require the
7425 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
7426 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
7427 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
7428 </p>
7431 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
7432 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
7433 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
7434 file, then the following should be done:
7435 <enumlist compact="compact">
7436 <item>
7437 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
7438 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
7439 scripts as described in the previous section.
7440 </item>
7441 <item>
7442 The owning package should also provide a program
7443 that the other packages may use to modify the
7444 configuration file.
7445 </item>
7446 <item>
7447 The related packages must use the provided program
7448 to make any desired modifications to the
7449 configuration file. They should either depend on
7450 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
7451 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
7452 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
7453 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
7454 configuration file may not even be present in the
7455 latter scenario.)
7456 </item>
7457 </enumlist>
7458 </p>
7461 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
7462 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
7463 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
7464 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
7465 </p>
7466 </sect1>
7468 <sect1>
7469 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
7472 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
7473 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
7474 No other program should reference the files in
7475 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7476 </p>
7479 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
7480 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
7481 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
7482 configuration file.
7483 </p>
7486 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
7487 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
7488 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
7489 </p>
7492 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
7493 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
7494 default behavior as possible.
7495 </p>
7498 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
7499 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
7500 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
7501 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
7502 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
7503 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
7504 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7505 </p>
7508 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
7509 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
7510 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
7511 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
7512 existing users when a package is installed.
7513 </p>
7514 </sect1>
7515 </sect>
7517 <sect>
7518 <heading>Log files</heading>
7520 Log files should usually be named
7521 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
7522 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
7523 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
7524 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
7525 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
7526 files there.
7527 </p>
7530 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't
7531 grow indefinitely; the best way to do this is to drop a log
7532 rotation configuration file into the directory
7533 <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file> and use the facilities provided by
7534 logrotate.<footnote>
7536 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
7537 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
7538 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
7539 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
7540 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
7541 by automatically installing a system which can be used
7542 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
7543 </p>
7546 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
7547 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
7548 It has both a configuration file
7549 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
7550 packages can drop their individual log rotation
7551 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
7552 </p>
7553 </footnote>
7554 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
7555 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
7556 section="8">):
7557 <example compact="compact">
7558 /var/log/foo/*.log {
7559 rotate 12
7560 weekly
7561 compress
7562 postrotate
7563 /etc/init.d/foo force-reload
7564 endscript
7566 </example>
7567 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
7568 compressed generations, and forces the daemon to reload its
7569 configuration information after the log rotation.
7570 </p>
7573 Log files should be removed when the package is
7574 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
7575 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
7576 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
7577 id="removedetails">).
7578 </p>
7579 </sect>
7581 <sect>
7582 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
7585 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
7586 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
7587 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
7588 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
7589 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
7590 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
7591 </p>
7594 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
7595 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
7596 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
7597 </p>
7600 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
7601 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
7602 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
7603 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
7604 it.<footnote>
7606 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
7607 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
7608 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
7609 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
7610 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
7611 directories already on the system does not change on
7612 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
7613 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
7614 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
7615 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
7616 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
7617 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
7618 </p>
7619 </footnote>
7620 </p>
7624 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
7625 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
7626 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
7627 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
7628 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
7629 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
7630 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
7631 on non-set-id executables.
7632 </p>
7635 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
7636 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
7637 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
7638 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
7639 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
7640 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
7641 execute them.
7642 </p>
7645 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
7646 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
7647 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
7648 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
7649 described below.<footnote>
7650 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
7651 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
7652 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
7653 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
7654 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
7655 default behavior. If you use this method, you should
7656 remember to describe <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in
7657 the package documentation; being a relatively new
7658 addition to Debian, it is probably not yet well-known.
7659 </footnote>
7660 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
7661 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
7662 executables executable only by that group.
7663 </p>
7666 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
7667 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
7668 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
7669 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
7670 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
7671 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
7672 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
7675 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
7676 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
7677 and must not release the package until you have been
7678 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
7679 either make the package depend on a version of the
7680 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
7681 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
7682 your package to create the user or group itself with the
7683 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
7684 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
7685 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
7686 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
7687 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
7688 </p>
7691 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
7692 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
7693 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
7694 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
7695 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
7696 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
7697 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
7698 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
7699 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
7700 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
7701 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
7702 preferred if it is possible).
7703 </p>
7706 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
7707 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
7708 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
7709 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
7710 changing your mind later will cause problems.
7711 </p>
7713 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
7715 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
7716 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
7717 </p>
7720 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
7721 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
7722 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
7723 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
7724 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
7725 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
7726 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
7727 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
7728 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
7729 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
7730 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
7731 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
7732 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
7733 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
7734 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
7735 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
7736 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
7737 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
7738 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
7739 </p>
7742 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
7743 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
7744 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
7745 one type of situation, though, where calls to
7746 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
7747 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
7748 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
7749 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
7750 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
7751 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
7752 <example>
7753 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
7755 # only do something when no setting exists
7756 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
7757 then
7758 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
7759 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
7760 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
7763 done
7764 </example>
7765 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
7766 is purged would be:
7767 <example>
7768 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
7770 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
7771 then
7772 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
7774 done
7775 </example>
7776 </p>
7777 </sect1>
7778 </sect>
7779 </chapt>
7782 <chapt id="customized-programs">
7783 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
7785 <sect id="arch-spec">
7786 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
7789 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
7790 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the
7791 strings provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The
7792 strings are in the format
7793 <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS part
7794 is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.<footnote>
7795 <p>Currently, the strings are:
7796 i386 ia64 alpha amd64 armeb arm hppa m32r m68k mips
7797 mipsel powerpc ppc64 s390 s390x sh3 sh3eb sh4 sh4eb
7798 sparc darwin-i386 darwin-ia64 darwin-alpha darwin-amd64
7799 darwin-armeb darwin-arm darwin-hppa darwin-m32r
7800 darwin-m68k darwin-mips darwin-mipsel darwin-powerpc
7801 darwin-ppc64 darwin-s390 darwin-s390x darwin-sh3
7802 darwin-sh3eb darwin-sh4 darwin-sh4eb darwin-sparc
7803 freebsd-i386 freebsd-ia64 freebsd-alpha freebsd-amd64
7804 freebsd-armeb freebsd-arm freebsd-hppa freebsd-m32r
7805 freebsd-m68k freebsd-mips freebsd-mipsel freebsd-powerpc
7806 freebsd-ppc64 freebsd-s390 freebsd-s390x freebsd-sh3
7807 freebsd-sh3eb freebsd-sh4 freebsd-sh4eb freebsd-sparc
7808 kfreebsd-i386 kfreebsd-ia64 kfreebsd-alpha
7809 kfreebsd-amd64 kfreebsd-armeb kfreebsd-arm kfreebsd-hppa
7810 kfreebsd-m32r kfreebsd-m68k kfreebsd-mips
7811 kfreebsd-mipsel kfreebsd-powerpc kfreebsd-ppc64
7812 kfreebsd-s390 kfreebsd-s390x kfreebsd-sh3 kfreebsd-sh3eb
7813 kfreebsd-sh4 kfreebsd-sh4eb kfreebsd-sparc knetbsd-i386
7814 knetbsd-ia64 knetbsd-alpha knetbsd-amd64 knetbsd-armeb
7815 knetbsd-arm knetbsd-hppa knetbsd-m32r knetbsd-m68k
7816 knetbsd-mips knetbsd-mipsel knetbsd-powerpc
7817 knetbsd-ppc64 knetbsd-s390 knetbsd-s390x knetbsd-sh3
7818 knetbsd-sh3eb knetbsd-sh4 knetbsd-sh4eb knetbsd-sparc
7819 netbsd-i386 netbsd-ia64 netbsd-alpha netbsd-amd64
7820 netbsd-armeb netbsd-arm netbsd-hppa netbsd-m32r
7821 netbsd-m68k netbsd-mips netbsd-mipsel netbsd-powerpc
7822 netbsd-ppc64 netbsd-s390 netbsd-s390x netbsd-sh3
7823 netbsd-sh3eb netbsd-sh4 netbsd-sh4eb netbsd-sparc
7824 openbsd-i386 openbsd-ia64 openbsd-alpha openbsd-amd64
7825 openbsd-armeb openbsd-arm openbsd-hppa openbsd-m32r
7826 openbsd-m68k openbsd-mips openbsd-mipsel openbsd-powerpc
7827 openbsd-ppc64 openbsd-s390 openbsd-s390x openbsd-sh3
7828 openbsd-sh3eb openbsd-sh4 openbsd-sh4eb openbsd-sparc
7829 hurd-i386 hurd-ia64 hurd-alpha hurd-amd64 hurd-armeb
7830 hurd-arm hurd-hppa hurd-m32r hurd-m68k hurd-mips
7831 hurd-mipsel hurd-powerpc hurd-ppc64 hurd-s390 hurd-s390x
7832 hurd-sh3 hurd-sh3eb hurd-sh4 hurd-sh4eb hurd-sparc
7833 </p>
7834 </footnote>
7835 </p>
7838 Note that we don't want to use
7839 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
7840 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
7841 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
7842 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
7843 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
7844 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
7845 </p>
7846 </sect>
7848 <sect>
7849 <heading>Daemons</heading>
7852 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
7853 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
7854 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
7855 by other packages.
7856 </p>
7859 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
7860 maintainer should get in contact with the
7861 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
7862 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
7863 package.
7864 </p>
7867 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
7868 modified by the package's scripts except via the
7869 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
7870 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
7871 for details on how to add entries.
7872 </p>
7875 If a package wants to install an example entry into
7876 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
7877 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
7878 treated as "commented out by user" by the
7879 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
7880 activated during package updates.
7881 </p>
7882 </sect>
7884 <sect>
7885 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
7886 lastlog</heading>
7889 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
7890 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
7891 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
7892 is required for other functionality.
7893 </p>
7896 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
7897 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
7898 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
7899 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
7900 </p>
7901 </sect>
7903 <sect>
7904 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
7907 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
7908 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
7909 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
7910 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
7911 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
7912 pager.
7913 </p>
7916 In addition, every program should choose a good default
7917 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
7918 administrator.
7919 </p>
7922 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
7923 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
7924 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
7925 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
7926 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
7927 </p>
7930 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7931 "alternatives" mechanism. Thus every package providing an
7932 editor or pager must call the
7933 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to register these
7934 programs.
7935 </p>
7938 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
7939 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
7940 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
7941 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
7942 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
7943 Debian base system that check the EDITOR and PAGER variables
7944 and launch the appropriate program, and fall back to
7945 <file>/usr/bin/editor</file> and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the
7946 variable is not set.
7947 </p>
7950 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
7951 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
7952 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
7953 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
7954 </p>
7957 It is not required for a package to depend on
7958 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
7959 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
7960 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
7961 pager program.
7962 </footnote>
7963 </p>
7964 </sect>
7966 <sect id="web-appl">
7967 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
7970 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
7971 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
7972 Debian system.
7973 </p>
7976 <enumlist>
7977 <item>
7978 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
7979 directory
7980 <example compact="compact">
7981 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
7982 </example>
7983 and should be referred to as
7984 <example compact="compact">
7985 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
7986 </example>
7988 </item>
7990 <item>
7991 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
7994 HTML documents for a package are stored in
7995 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
7996 and can be referred to as
7997 <example compact="compact">
7998 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
7999 </example>
8000 </p>
8003 The web server should restrict access to the document
8004 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8005 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8006 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8007 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8008 </p>
8009 </item>
8011 <item>
8012 <p>Access to images</p>
8014 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8015 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8016 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8018 <example>
8019 http://localhost/images/&lt;package&gt;/&lt;filename&gt;
8020 </example>
8022 </p>
8023 </item>
8025 <item>
8026 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8029 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8030 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8031 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8032 documents and register the Web Application via the
8033 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8034 web document root is unavoidable then use
8035 <example compact="compact">
8036 /var/www
8037 </example>
8038 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8039 link to the location where the system administrator
8040 has put the real document root.
8041 </p>
8042 </item>
8043 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8045 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8046 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8047 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8048 </p>
8050 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8051 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8052 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8053 <tt>httpd-cgi</tt>.
8054 </p>
8055 </item>
8056 </enumlist>
8057 </p>
8058 </sect>
8060 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8061 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8064 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8065 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8066 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8067 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8068 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8069 damage!
8070 </p>
8073 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8074 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8075 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8076 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8077 access to the mail spool should be via the
8078 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8079 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8080 </p>
8083 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8084 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8085 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8086 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8087 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8088 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8089 a non blocking way<footnote>
8090 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8091 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8092 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8093 time, and start over locking again.
8094 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8095 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8096 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8097 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (&gt;&gt;1.01)</tt>
8098 to use these functions.
8099 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8100 </p>
8103 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8104 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8105 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8106 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8107 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8108 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8109 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8110 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8111 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8112 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8113 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8114 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8115 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8116 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8117 permits either scheme.
8118 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8119 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8120 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8121 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8122 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8123 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8124 </p>
8127 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8128 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8129 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8130 using this privilege).</p>
8133 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8134 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8135 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8136 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8137 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8138 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8139 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8140 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8141 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8142 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8143 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control file
8144 fields.
8145 </p>
8148 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8149 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8150 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8153 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8154 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8155 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8156 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8157 is supported.</p>
8160 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8161 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8162 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8163 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8164 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8165 (followed by a newline).
8166 </p>
8169 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8170 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8171 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8172 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8173 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8174 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8175 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8176 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8177 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8178 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8179 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8180 <example compact="compact">
8181 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8182 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8183 news and mail messages. The default is
8184 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8185 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8186 </example>
8187 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8188 --fqdn</tt>.
8189 </p>
8190 </sect>
8192 <sect>
8193 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8196 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8197 servers and clients should be located under
8198 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8201 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8202 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8203 are:
8205 <taglist>
8206 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8207 <item>
8208 A string which should appear as the
8209 organization header for all messages posted
8210 by NNTP clients on the machine
8211 </item>
8213 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8214 <item>
8215 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8216 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8217 an NNTP server.
8218 </item>
8219 </taglist>
8221 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8222 configuration.
8223 </p>
8224 </sect>
8227 <sect>
8228 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
8230 <sect1>
8231 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
8234 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
8235 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
8236 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
8237 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
8238 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
8239 on which it depends, it is required that either the
8240 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
8241 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
8242 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
8243 lowered.
8244 </p>
8245 </sect1>
8247 <sect1>
8248 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
8251 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
8252 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
8253 hardware should declare in their control data that they
8254 provide the virtual package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
8255 This implements current practice, and provides an
8256 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
8257 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
8258 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
8259 directly with the display and input hardware or via
8260 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
8261 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
8262 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
8263 </footnote>
8264 </p>
8265 </sect1>
8267 <sect1>
8268 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
8271 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
8272 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare
8273 in their control data that they provide the virtual
8274 package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should also
8275 register themselves as an alternative for
8276 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
8278 </p>
8281 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
8282 <list compact="compact">
8283 <item>
8284 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
8285 compatible terminal.
8286 </item>
8288 <item>
8289 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
8290 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
8291 terminal window<footnote>
8292 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
8293 a new top-level X window directly parented by
8294 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
8295 emulator application were so coded, be a new
8296 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
8297 </footnote>
8298 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
8299 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
8300 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
8301 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
8302 </item>
8304 <item>
8305 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
8306 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
8307 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
8308 </item>
8309 </list>
8310 </p>
8311 </sect1>
8313 <sect1>
8314 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
8317 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
8318 their control data that they provide the virtual package
8319 <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also register
8320 themselves as an alternative for
8321 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
8322 calculated as follows:
8323 <list compact="compact">
8324 <item>
8325 Start with a priority of 20.
8326 </item>
8328 <item>
8329 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
8330 system, add 20 points if this support is available
8331 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
8332 configuration files belonging to the system or user
8333 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
8334 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
8335 points.
8336 </p>
8337 </item>
8339 <item>
8340 If the window manager complies with <url
8341 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/Standards/wm-spec"
8342 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
8343 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/"
8344 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
8345 </item>
8347 <item>
8348 If the window manager permits the X session to be
8349 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
8350 (without killing the X server) in its default
8351 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
8352 </item>
8353 </list>
8354 </p>
8355 </sect1>
8357 <sect1>
8358 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
8361 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
8362 System<footnote>
8363 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
8364 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
8365 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
8366 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
8367 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
8368 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
8369 font policy.
8370 </footnote>
8371 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
8372 available without modification of the X or font server
8373 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
8374 other font packages to register information about
8375 themselves.
8376 <enumlist>
8377 <item>
8378 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
8379 must be in a separate binary package from any
8380 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
8381 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
8382 license information). If one or more of the fonts
8383 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
8384 the package with which they are associated the font
8385 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
8386 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
8387 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
8388 packages.<footnote>
8389 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
8390 from the local file system or over the network
8391 from an X font server; the Debian package system
8392 is empowered to deal only with the local
8393 file system.
8394 </footnote>
8395 </item>
8397 <item>
8398 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
8399 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
8400 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
8401 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
8402 resolution:
8403 <list compact="compact">
8404 <item>
8405 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
8406 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
8407 </item>
8409 <item>
8410 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
8411 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
8412 </item>
8414 <item>
8415 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
8416 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
8417 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
8418 </item>
8419 </list>
8420 </item>
8422 <item>
8423 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
8424 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
8425 metric files are available, they must be placed here
8426 as well.
8427 </item>
8429 <item>
8430 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
8431 other than those listed above must be neither
8432 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
8433 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
8434 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
8435 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
8436 </item>
8438 <item>
8439 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
8440 in the X font directories listed above, provide
8441 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
8442 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
8443 a location must comply with the FHS.
8444 </item>
8446 <item>
8447 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
8448 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
8449 they should be provided in separate binary packages
8450 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
8451 the names of the packages containing the
8452 corresponding fonts.
8453 </item>
8455 <item>
8456 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
8457 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
8458 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
8459 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
8460 its name.
8461 </item>
8463 <item>
8464 Font packages must not provide the files
8465 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
8466 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
8467 <list>
8468 <item>
8469 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
8470 </item>
8472 <item>
8473 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
8474 files, if needed, should be provided in the
8475 directory
8476 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
8477 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
8478 subdirectory of
8479 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
8480 package's corresponding fonts are stored
8481 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
8482 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
8483 that provides these fonts, and
8484 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
8485 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
8486 the file contents.
8487 </item>
8488 </list>
8489 </item>
8491 <item>
8492 Font packages must declare a dependency on
8493 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their control
8494 data.
8495 </item>
8497 <item>
8498 Font packages that provide one or more
8499 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
8500 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
8501 directory into which they installed fonts
8502 <em>before</em> invoking
8503 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
8504 This invocation must occur in both the
8505 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8506 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8507 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8508 </item>
8510 <item>
8511 Font packages that provide one or more
8512 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
8513 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
8514 directory into which they installed fonts. This
8515 invocation must occur in both the
8516 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8517 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8518 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8519 </item>
8521 <item>
8522 Font packages must invoke
8523 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
8524 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
8525 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
8526 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
8527 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8528 </item>
8530 <item>
8531 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
8532 fonts they include which collide with alias names
8533 already in use by fonts already packaged.
8534 </item>
8536 <item>
8537 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
8538 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
8539 </item>
8540 </enumlist>
8541 </p>
8542 </sect1>
8544 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
8545 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
8548 Application defaults files must be installed in the
8549 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
8550 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
8551 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
8552 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
8553 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
8554 configuration files.
8555 </p>
8558 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
8559 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
8560 as that of the package placed in the
8561 <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which must
8562 registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
8563 configuration file.<footnote>
8564 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
8565 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
8566 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
8567 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
8568 clients.
8569 </footnote>
8570 </p>
8571 </sect1>
8573 <sect1>
8574 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
8577 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
8578 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
8579 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
8580 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
8581 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
8582 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
8583 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
8584 regarded as obsolete.
8585 </p>
8588 Include files previously installed under
8589 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
8590 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
8591 installed into subdirectories of
8592 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
8593 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
8594 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
8595 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
8596 </p>
8599 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
8600 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
8601 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
8602 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
8603 Other X Window System applications should use
8604 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
8605 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
8606 </p>
8607 </sect1>
8609 <sect1>
8610 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
8613 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
8614 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
8615 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
8616 "Motif" in this policy document.
8617 </footnote>
8618 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
8619 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
8620 judges that the program or programs do not work
8621 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
8622 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
8623 versions of the package should be created; one linked
8624 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
8625 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
8626 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
8627 package name.
8628 </p>
8631 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
8632 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
8633 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
8634 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
8635 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
8636 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
8637 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
8638 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
8639 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
8640 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
8641 </p>
8642 </sect1>
8643 </sect>
8645 <sect id="perl">
8646 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
8649 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
8650 </p>
8653 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
8654 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
8655 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8656 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
8657 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
8658 </p>
8659 </sect>
8661 <sect id="emacs">
8662 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
8665 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
8666 package emacs lisp programs.
8667 </p>
8670 The Emacs policy is available in
8671 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
8672 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
8673 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8674 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
8675 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
8676 </p>
8677 </sect>
8679 <sect>
8680 <heading>Games</heading>
8683 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
8684 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
8685 </p>
8688 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
8691 Games which require protected, privileged access to
8692 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
8693 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
8694 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
8695 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
8696 example). They must not be made
8697 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
8698 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
8699 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
8700 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
8701 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
8702 important game data, and if they can get at the other
8703 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
8704 effort.)</p>
8707 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
8708 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
8709 data files or other static information made unreadable so
8710 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
8711 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
8712 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
8713 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
8714 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
8715 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
8716 security hole.</p>
8719 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
8720 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
8721 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
8722 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
8723 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
8724 </sect>
8725 </chapt>
8728 <chapt id="docs">
8729 <heading>Documentation</heading>
8731 <sect>
8732 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
8735 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
8736 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
8737 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
8738 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
8739 </p>
8742 Each program, utility, and function should have an
8743 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
8744 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
8745 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
8746 auxiliary things are optional.
8747 </p>
8750 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
8751 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
8752 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
8753 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
8754 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
8755 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
8756 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
8757 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
8758 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples
8759 created by <prgn>debmake</prgn> or <prgn>dh_make</prgn>,
8760 the helper programs <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
8761 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
8762 </footnote>
8763 </p>
8766 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
8767 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
8768 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
8769 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
8770 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
8771 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
8772 anyway.
8773 </p>
8776 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
8777 </p>
8780 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
8781 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
8782 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
8783 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
8784 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
8785 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
8786 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
8787 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
8788 base of the man page tree (usually
8789 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
8790 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
8791 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
8792 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
8793 man page under those names based solely on the information in
8794 the man page's header.<footnote>
8795 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
8796 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
8797 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
8798 database that would be better left in the file system.
8799 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
8800 be present in the future.
8801 </footnote>
8802 </p>
8805 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
8806 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
8807 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
8808 to the shortest relevant locale name in
8809 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
8810 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
8811 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
8812 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
8813 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
8814 UTF-8.
8815 </footnote>
8816 </p>
8819 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
8820 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
8821 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
8822 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
8823 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
8824 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
8825 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
8826 </footnote>
8827 </p>
8830 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
8831 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
8832 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
8833 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
8834 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
8835 the original language instead of the target language.
8836 </p>
8837 </sect>
8839 <sect>
8840 <heading>Info documents</heading>
8843 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
8844 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
8845 </p>
8848 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
8849 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for
8850 the use of info readers.<footnote>
8851 It was previously necessary for packages installing info
8852 documents to run <prgn>install-info</prgn> from maintainer
8853 scripts. This is no longer necessary. The installation
8854 system now uses dpkg hooks.
8855 </footnote>
8856 This file must not be included in packages.
8857 </p>
8860 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
8861 information in the document for the use
8862 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
8863 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
8864 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
8865 entries should be included between
8866 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
8867 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
8868 <example>
8869 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
8870 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
8871 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
8872 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
8873 </example>
8874 To determine which section to use, you should look
8875 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
8876 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
8877 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
8878 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
8879 To include this information in the generated info document, if
8880 it is absent, add commands like:
8881 <example>
8882 @dircategory Individual utilities
8883 @direntry
8884 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
8885 @end direntry
8886 </example>
8887 </footnote>
8888 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
8889 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
8890 </p>
8891 </sect>
8893 <sect>
8894 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
8897 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
8898 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
8899 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
8900 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
8901 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
8902 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
8903 </p>
8906 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
8907 many users of the package will not require you should create
8908 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
8909 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
8910 or want it installed.</p>
8913 It is often a good idea to put text information files
8914 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
8915 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8916 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
8917 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
8918 course!</p>
8921 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
8922 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
8923 <footnote>
8924 The system administrator should be able to
8925 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
8926 any programs to break.
8927 </footnote>.
8928 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
8929 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
8930 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
8931 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
8932 </p>
8935 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
8936 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
8937 the two packages both come from the same source and the
8938 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
8940 Please note that this does not override the section on
8941 changelog files below, so the file
8942 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
8943 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
8944 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
8945 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
8946 symlink must be the same (same source package and
8947 version).
8948 </p>
8949 </footnote>
8950 </p>
8953 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
8954 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
8955 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
8956 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
8957 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
8958 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
8959 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
8960 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
8961 </footnote>
8962 </p>
8963 </sect>
8965 <sect>
8966 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
8969 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
8970 via HTML.</p>
8973 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
8974 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
8975 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
8976 package, in the directory
8977 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
8978 its subdirectories.<footnote>
8979 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
8980 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
8981 necessarily in the main binary package.
8982 </footnote>
8983 </p>
8986 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
8987 package maintainer's discretion.
8988 </p>
8989 </sect>
8991 <sect id="copyrightfile">
8992 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
8995 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
8996 copyright and distribution license in the file
8997 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
8998 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
8999 </p>
9002 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
9003 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
9004 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
9005 involved with its creation.
9006 </p>
9009 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9010 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9011 part of the Debian GNU/Linux distribution and briefly explain
9012 why.
9013 </p>
9016 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9017 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9018 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9019 </p>
9022 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9023 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9024 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9025 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9026 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9027 mechanical means.
9028 </p>
9031 Packages distributed under the UCB BSD license, the Apache
9032 license (version 2.0), the Artistic license, the GNU GPL
9033 (version 2 or 3), the GNU LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the
9034 GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or 1.3) should refer to the corresponding
9035 files under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9037 In particular,
9038 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>,
9039 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9040 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9041 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9042 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9043 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9044 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9045 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9046 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9047 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9048 respectively.
9049 </p>
9050 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9051 file.
9052 </p>
9055 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9056 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9057 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9058 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9059 </sect>
9061 <sect>
9062 <heading>Examples</heading>
9065 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9066 should be installed in a directory
9067 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9068 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9069 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9070 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9071 should be installed in a directory
9072 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9073 links to them from
9074 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9075 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9076 former.
9077 </p>
9080 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9081 example files may be installed into
9082 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9083 </p>
9084 </sect>
9086 <sect id="changelogs">
9087 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9090 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9091 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9092 the Debian source tree in
9093 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9094 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9095 </p>
9098 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9099 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9100 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9101 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9102 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9103 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9104 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9105 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9106 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9107 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9108 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9109 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9110 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9111 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9112 </footnote>
9113 </p>
9116 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9117 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9118 if they start out small.
9119 </p>
9122 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9123 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9124 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9125 usually be installed as
9126 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9127 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9128 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9129 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9130 </p>
9133 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9134 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9135 </p>
9136 </sect>
9137 </chapt>
9139 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9140 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9143 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9144 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9145 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9146 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9147 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9148 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9149 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9150 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9151 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9152 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9153 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9154 </p>
9157 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9158 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9159 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9160 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9161 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9162 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9163 done in due course.
9164 </p>
9167 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9168 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9169 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9170 </p>
9173 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9174 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9175 systems.<footnote>
9176 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian
9177 GNU/Linux, but may work on or be ported to other
9178 systems.
9179 </footnote>
9180 </p>
9183 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9184 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9185 their associated data, though source code examples and
9186 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9189 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9190 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9191 behavior of the package management programs
9192 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9193 they interact with packages.</p>
9196 It also documents the interaction between
9197 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9198 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9199 how to create a new access method.</p>
9202 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9203 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9204 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9205 man pages.
9206 </p>
9209 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9210 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9211 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9212 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9213 please see their man pages.
9214 </p>
9217 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
9218 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
9219 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
9220 </p>
9223 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided
9224 as an example for people wishing to create Debian
9225 packages. The Debian <prgn>debmake</prgn> package is
9226 recommended as a very helpful tool in creating and maintaining
9227 Debian packages. However, while the tools and examples are
9228 helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the
9229 Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
9230 </appendix>
9232 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
9233 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
9236 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
9237 consists of various control information files and scripts used
9238 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
9239 id="pkg-controlarea">.
9240 </p>
9243 The second part is an archive containing the files and
9244 directories to be installed.
9245 </p>
9248 In the future binary packages may also contain other
9249 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
9250 format for the archive is described in full in the
9251 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
9252 </p>
9255 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
9256 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
9257 </heading>
9260 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
9261 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
9262 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
9263 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9264 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
9265 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
9266 arguments.)
9267 </p>
9270 In order to create a binary package you must make a
9271 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
9272 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
9273 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
9274 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
9275 source tree.
9276 </p>
9279 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
9280 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
9281 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
9282 they are installed.
9283 </p>
9286 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
9287 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
9288 used should be the same on the system where the package is
9289 built and the one where it is installed.
9290 </p>
9293 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
9294 miniature file system tree you're creating:
9295 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
9296 information files, notably the binary package control file
9297 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
9298 </p>
9301 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
9302 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
9303 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is installed.
9304 </p>
9307 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
9308 <example>
9309 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
9310 </example>
9311 </p>
9314 This will build the package in
9315 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
9316 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
9317 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
9318 build the package.)
9319 </p>
9322 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
9323 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
9324 output of following commands enlightening:
9325 <example>
9326 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
9327 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9328 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9329 </example>
9330 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
9331 <example>
9332 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
9333 </example>
9334 </p>
9335 </sect>
9337 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
9338 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
9341 The control information portion of a binary package is a
9342 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
9343 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
9344 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
9345 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
9346 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
9347 </p>
9350 It is possible to put other files in the package control
9351 area, but this is not generally a good idea (though they
9352 will largely be ignored).
9353 </p>
9356 Here is a brief list of the control info files supported by
9357 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
9358 </p>
9361 <taglist>
9362 <tag><tt>control</tt>
9363 <item>
9365 This is the key description file used by
9366 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
9367 and version, gives its description for the user,
9368 states its relationships with other packages, and so
9369 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
9370 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9371 </p>
9374 It is usually generated automatically from information
9375 in the source package by the
9376 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
9377 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
9378 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
9379 </p>
9380 </item>
9382 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
9383 <tt>prerm</tt>
9384 </tag>
9385 <item>
9387 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
9388 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
9389 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
9390 deal with matters which are particular to that package
9391 or require more complicated processing than that
9392 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
9393 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
9394 </p>
9397 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
9398 See <ref id="idempotency">.
9399 </p>
9402 The maintainer scripts are guaranteed to run with a
9403 controlling terminal and can interact with the user.
9404 See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
9405 </p>
9406 </item>
9408 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
9409 </tag>
9410 <item>
9411 This file contains a list of configuration files which
9412 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9413 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
9414 every configuration file should be listed here.
9415 </item>
9417 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
9418 </tag>
9419 <item>
9420 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
9421 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
9422 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
9423 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
9424 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
9425 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
9426 </item>
9427 </taglist>
9428 </p>
9430 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
9431 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
9434 The most important control information file used by
9435 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
9436 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
9437 statistics".
9438 </p>
9441 The binary package control files of packages built from
9442 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
9443 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
9444 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
9445 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
9446 more details.
9447 </p>
9450 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
9451 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9452 </p>
9455 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
9456 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
9457 </p>
9458 </sect>
9460 <sect>
9461 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
9464 See <ref id="timestamps">.
9465 </p>
9466 </sect>
9467 </appendix>
9469 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
9470 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
9473 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
9474 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
9475 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
9476 </p>
9478 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
9479 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
9482 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
9483 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
9484 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
9485 </p>
9488 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
9489 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
9490 documentation about their arguments and operation.
9491 </p>
9494 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
9495 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
9496 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
9497 package.
9498 </p>
9500 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
9501 <heading>
9502 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
9503 packages
9504 </heading>
9507 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
9508 called from package-independent automated building scripts
9509 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
9510 </p>
9513 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
9514 <example>
9515 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
9516 </example>
9517 </p>
9520 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
9521 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
9522 the same directory. It unpacks into
9523 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
9524 applicable
9525 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
9526 the current directory.
9527 </p>
9530 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
9531 <example>
9532 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
9533 </example>
9534 </p>
9537 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
9538 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
9539 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
9540 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
9541 required.
9542 </p>
9545 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
9546 </sect1>
9549 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
9550 <heading>
9551 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
9552 control script
9553 </heading>
9556 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
9557 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
9558 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
9559 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
9560 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
9561 source and binary package upload.
9562 </p>
9565 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
9566 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
9567 no arguments; useful arguments include:
9568 <taglist compact="compact">
9569 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
9570 <item>
9572 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
9573 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
9574 </item>
9575 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
9576 <item>
9578 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
9579 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
9580 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
9581 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
9582 </item>
9583 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
9584 <item>
9586 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
9587 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
9588 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
9589 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
9590 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
9591 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
9592 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
9593 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
9594 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
9595 start with.</p>
9596 </item>
9597 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
9598 <item>
9600 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
9601 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
9602 </p>
9603 </item>
9604 </taglist>
9605 </p>
9606 </sect1>
9608 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
9609 <heading>
9610 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
9611 control files
9612 </heading>
9615 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9616 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
9617 tree.
9618 </p>
9621 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
9622 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
9623 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
9624 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
9625 <footnote>
9626 This is so that the control file which is produced has
9627 the right permissions
9628 </footnote>.
9629 </p>
9632 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
9633 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
9634 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
9635 the installed size of a package is correct.
9636 </p>
9639 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
9640 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
9641 variable substitutions created by
9642 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
9643 are available.
9644 </p>
9647 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
9648 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
9649 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
9650 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
9651 </p>
9654 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
9655 something like:
9656 <example>
9657 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
9658 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
9659 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
9660 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
9661 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
9662 </p>
9665 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
9666 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
9667 (for example) a future invocation of
9668 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
9669 </sect1>
9671 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
9672 <heading>
9673 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
9674 dependencies
9675 </heading>
9678 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9679 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
9680 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
9681 </p>
9684 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
9685 <footnote>
9687 They may be specified either in the locations in the
9688 source tree where they are created or in the locations
9689 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
9690 prior to binary package creation.
9691 </p>
9692 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
9693 be included in the binary package's control file.
9694 </p>
9697 If some of the found shared libraries should only
9698 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
9699 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
9700 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
9701 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
9702 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
9703 </p>
9706 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
9707 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
9708 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
9709 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
9710 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
9711 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
9712 control file.
9713 </p>
9716 For example, a package that generates an essential part
9717 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
9718 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
9719 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
9720 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
9721 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
9722 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
9723 even more optional features provided by unzip.
9724 </footnote>
9725 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
9726 <example>
9727 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
9728 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
9729 </example>
9730 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
9731 <example>
9732 <var>...</var>
9733 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
9734 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
9735 <var>...</var>
9736 </example>
9737 </p>
9740 Sources which produce several binary packages with
9741 different shared library dependency requirements can use
9742 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
9743 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
9744 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
9745 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
9746 variables, each of the form
9747 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
9748 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
9749 binary package control files.
9750 </p>
9751 </sect1>
9754 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
9755 <heading>
9756 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
9757 <file>debian/files</file>
9758 </heading>
9761 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
9762 the source and binary package files.
9763 </p>
9766 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
9767 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
9768 the <file>.changes</file> file when
9769 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
9770 </p>
9773 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
9774 <file>debian/rules</file>:
9775 <example>
9776 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
9777 </example>
9778 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
9779 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
9780 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
9781 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
9782 file there just before or just after calling
9783 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
9784 </p>
9787 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
9788 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
9789 </p>
9790 </sect1>
9793 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
9794 <heading>
9795 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
9796 upload control file
9797 </heading>
9800 This program is usually called by package-independent
9801 automatic building scripts such as
9802 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
9803 by hand.
9804 </p>
9807 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
9808 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
9809 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
9810 information in the source package's changelog and control
9811 file and the binary and source packages which should have
9812 been built.
9813 </p>
9814 </sect1>
9817 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
9818 <heading>
9819 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
9820 representation of a changelog
9821 </heading>
9824 This program is used internally by
9825 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
9826 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
9827 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
9828 and prints a control-file format representation of the
9829 information in it to standard output.
9830 </p>
9831 </sect1>
9833 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
9834 <heading>
9835 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
9836 host system
9837 </heading>
9840 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
9841 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
9842 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
9843 architecture for the package building process.
9844 </p>
9845 </sect1>
9846 </sect>
9848 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
9849 <heading>The Debianised source tree</heading>
9852 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
9853 allow a Debianised source tree with some associated control
9854 information to be reproduced and transported easily. The
9855 Debianised source tree is a version of the original program
9856 with certain files added for the benefit of the
9857 Debianisation process, and with any other changes required
9858 made to the rest of the source code and installation
9859 scripts.
9860 </p>
9863 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
9864 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debianised source
9865 tree. They are described below.
9866 </p>
9868 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
9869 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
9872 See <ref id="debianrules">.
9873 </p>
9874 </sect1>
9877 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkgchangelog">
9878 <heading><file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
9881 See <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9882 </p>
9884 <sect2><heading>Defining alternative changelog formats
9885 </heading>
9888 It is possible to use a different format to the standard
9889 one, by providing a parser for the format you wish to
9890 use.
9891 </p>
9894 In order to have <tt>dpkg-parsechangelog</tt> run your
9895 parser, you must include a line within the last 40 lines
9896 of your file matching the Perl regular expression:
9897 <tt>\schangelog-format:\s+([0-9a-z]+)\W</tt> The part in
9898 parentheses should be the name of the format. For
9899 example, you might say:
9900 <example>
9901 @@@ changelog-format: joebloggs @@@
9902 </example>
9903 Changelog format names are non-empty strings of alphanumerics.
9904 </p>
9907 If such a line exists then <tt>dpkg-parsechangelog</tt>
9908 will look for the parser as
9909 <file>/usr/lib/dpkg/parsechangelog/<var>format-name</var></file>
9911 <file>/usr/local/lib/dpkg/parsechangelog/<var>format-name</var></file>;
9912 it is an error for it not to find it, or for it not to
9913 be an executable program. The default changelog format
9914 is <tt>dpkg</tt>, and a parser for it is provided with
9915 the <tt>dpkg</tt> package.
9916 </p>
9919 The parser will be invoked with the changelog open on
9920 standard input at the start of the file. It should read
9921 the file (it may seek if it wishes) to determine the
9922 information required and return the parsed information
9923 to standard output in the form of a series of control
9924 fields in the standard format. By default it should
9925 return information about only the most recent version in
9926 the changelog; it should accept a
9927 <tt>-v<var>version</var></tt> option to return changes
9928 information from all versions present <em>strictly
9929 after</em> <var>version</var>, and it should then be an
9930 error for <var>version</var> not to be present in the
9931 changelog.
9932 </p>
9935 The fields are:
9936 <list compact="compact">
9937 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
9938 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9939 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9940 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9941 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9942 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref></item>
9943 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
9944 </list>
9945 </p>
9948 If several versions are being returned (due to the use
9949 of <tt>-v</tt>), the urgency value should be of the
9950 highest urgency code listed at the start of any of the
9951 versions requested followed by the concatenated
9952 (space-separated) comments from all the versions
9953 requested; the maintainer, version, distribution and
9954 date should always be from the most recent version.
9955 </p>
9958 For the format of the <tt>Changes</tt> field see
9959 <ref id="f-Changes">.
9960 </p>
9963 If the changelog format which is being parsed always or
9964 almost always leaves a blank line between individual
9965 change notes these blank lines should be stripped out,
9966 so as to make the resulting output compact.
9967 </p>
9970 If the changelog format does not contain date or package
9971 name information this information should be omitted from
9972 the output. The parser should not attempt to synthesize
9973 it or find it from other sources.
9974 </p>
9977 If the changelog does not have the expected format the
9978 parser should exit with a nonzero exit status, rather
9979 than trying to muddle through and possibly generating
9980 incorrect output.
9981 </p>
9984 A changelog parser may not interact with the user at
9985 all.
9986 </p>
9987 </sect2>
9988 </sect1>
9990 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
9991 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
9994 See <ref id="substvars">.
9995 </p>
9997 </sect1>
9999 <sect1>
10000 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
10003 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
10004 </p>
10005 </sect1>
10007 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
10008 </heading>
10011 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10012 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10013 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10014 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10015 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10016 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10017 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10018 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10019 </p>
10022 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10023 source tree it is usual to use several
10024 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10025 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10026 </p>
10029 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10030 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10031 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10032 </sect>
10035 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10036 </heading>
10039 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10040 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10041 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10042 </p>
10045 <taglist>
10046 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10047 <item>
10048 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10049 to extract a source package.
10050 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10051 </item>
10053 <tag>
10054 Original source archive -
10055 <file>
10056 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10057 </file>
10058 </tag>
10060 <item>
10062 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10063 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10064 the upstream authors of the program.
10065 </p>
10066 </item>
10068 <tag>
10069 Debianisation diff -
10070 <file>
10071 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10072 </file>
10073 </tag>
10074 <item>
10077 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10078 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10079 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10080 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10081 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10082 links and the characteristics of special files or
10083 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10084 or renamed.
10085 </p>
10088 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10089 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10090 tree, which will be created by
10091 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10092 </p>
10095 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10096 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10097 executable (see below).</p></item>
10098 </taglist>
10099 </p>
10102 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10103 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10104 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10105 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10106 tarfile is named
10107 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10108 and preferably contains a directory named
10109 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10110 </p>
10111 </sect>
10113 <sect>
10114 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10117 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10118 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10119 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10120 <enumlist compact="compact">
10121 <item>
10123 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10124 directory.</p>
10125 </item>
10126 <item>
10127 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10128 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10129 </item>
10130 <item>
10132 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10133 the source tree.</p>
10134 </item>
10135 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10136 </item>
10137 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10138 source code alongside the Debianised version.</p>
10139 </item>
10140 </enumlist>
10143 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10144 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10145 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10146 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10147 </p>
10149 <sect1>
10150 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10153 The source package may not contain any hard links
10154 <footnote>
10155 This is not currently detected when building source
10156 packages, but only when extracting
10157 them.
10158 </footnote>
10159 <footnote>
10160 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10161 future, but would require a fair amount of
10162 work.
10163 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10164 setgid files.
10165 <footnote>
10166 Setgid directories are allowed.
10167 </footnote>
10168 </p>
10171 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10172 original and Debianised source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10173 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10174 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the debianised
10175 source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10176 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10177 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10178 building the source package are:
10179 <list compact="compact">
10180 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10181 </item>
10182 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10183 </item>
10184 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10185 </item>
10186 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10187 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10188 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10189 <list compact="compact">
10190 <item>
10192 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10193 <footnote>
10194 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10195 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10196 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10197 and the creation of the new one.
10198 </footnote>
10199 </p>
10200 </item>
10201 <item>
10203 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10204 newline (either in the original or the modified
10205 source tree).
10206 </p>
10207 </item>
10208 </list>
10209 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10210 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10211 <list compact="compact">
10212 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10213 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10214 </list>
10215 </p>
10218 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10219 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10220 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10221 directory, and afterwards it will make
10222 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10223 </p>
10224 </sect1>
10225 </sect>
10226 </appendix>
10228 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10229 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10232 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10233 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10234 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10235 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10236 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10237 format.
10238 </p>
10240 <sect>
10241 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10244 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10245 </p>
10248 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10249 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10250 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10251 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10252 </p>
10253 </sect>
10255 <sect>
10256 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10259 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10260 </p>
10263 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10264 to the Policy manual.
10265 </p>
10267 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10268 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10271 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10272 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10273 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10274 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10275 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10276 by spaces.
10277 </p>
10278 </sect1>
10280 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10281 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10284 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10285 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10286 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10287 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10288 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10289 spaces.
10290 </p>
10291 </sect1>
10293 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10294 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10297 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10298 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10299 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10300 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10301 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10302 single word.
10303 </p>
10304 </sect1>
10306 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10307 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10310 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10311 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10312 version of the package which was successfully
10313 configured.
10314 </p>
10315 </sect1>
10317 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10318 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10321 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10322 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10323 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10324 appear anywhere in a package!
10325 </p>
10326 </sect1>
10328 <sect1>
10329 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
10332 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
10333 not appear anywhere any more.
10335 <taglist compact="compact">
10337 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
10338 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
10339 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
10340 <item>
10341 The Debian revision part of the package version was
10342 at one point in a separate control file field. This
10343 field went through several names.
10344 </item>
10346 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
10347 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
10349 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
10350 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
10352 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
10353 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
10355 </taglist>
10356 </p>
10357 </sect1>
10358 </sect>
10360 </appendix>
10362 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
10363 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10366 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
10367 handling of package configuration files.
10368 </p>
10371 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
10372 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
10373 particular configuration file.
10374 </p>
10377 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
10378 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
10379 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
10380 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
10381 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
10382 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
10383 </p>
10386 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
10387 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
10388 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
10389 versions of the package automatically. This will be
10390 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
10391 each system.
10392 </p>
10394 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
10395 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10396 </heading>
10399 A package may contain a control area file called
10400 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
10401 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
10402 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
10403 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
10404 package.
10405 </p>
10408 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
10409 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
10410 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
10411 script,
10412 </p>
10415 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
10416 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
10417 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
10418 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
10419 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
10420 version.
10421 </p>
10424 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
10425 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
10426 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
10427 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
10428 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
10429 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
10430 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
10431 installed (with an informative message). If both have
10432 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
10433 and must resolve the differences themselves.
10434 </p>
10437 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
10438 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
10439 was included in the most recent version of the package.
10440 </p>
10443 When a package is installed for the first time
10444 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
10445 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
10446 file system.
10447 </p>
10450 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
10451 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
10452 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
10453 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
10454 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
10455 kept that way if the user did it.
10456 </p>
10459 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
10460 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
10461 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
10462 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
10463 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
10464 </sect>
10466 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
10467 handling
10468 </heading>
10471 For files which contain site-specific information such as
10472 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
10473 better to create the file in the package's
10474 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
10475 </p>
10478 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
10479 of the system to determine values and other information, and
10480 may involve prompting the user for some information which
10481 can't be obtained some other way.
10482 </p>
10485 When using this method there are a couple of important
10486 issues which should be considered:
10487 </p>
10490 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
10491 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
10492 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
10493 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
10494 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
10495 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
10496 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
10497 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
10498 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
10499 deal with them correctly.
10500 </p>
10503 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
10504 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
10505 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
10506 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
10507 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
10508 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
10509 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
10510 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
10511 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
10512 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
10513 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
10514 overwrite it.</p></sect>
10515 </appendix>
10517 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
10518 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
10519 Packaging Manual)
10520 </heading>
10523 When several packages all provide different versions of the
10524 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
10525 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
10526 and have their decisions respected.
10527 </p>
10530 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
10531 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
10532 being installed at once, each under their own name
10533 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
10534 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
10535 refer to something, at least by default.
10536 </p>
10539 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
10540 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
10541 </p>
10544 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
10545 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
10546 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
10547 it).
10548 </p>
10551 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
10552 section="8"> for details.
10553 </p>
10556 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
10557 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
10558 </appendix>
10560 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
10561 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
10562 </heading>
10565 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
10566 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
10567 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
10568 </p>
10571 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
10572 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
10573 provide a wrapper for it).
10574 </p>
10577 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
10578 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
10579 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
10580 </p>
10583 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
10584 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
10585 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
10586 details of its operation.
10587 </p>
10590 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
10591 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
10592 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
10593 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
10594 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
10595 <example>
10596 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10597 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10598 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
10599 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
10600 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
10601 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
10602 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
10603 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
10604 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
10605 the package is being upgraded:
10606 <example>
10607 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10608 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10609 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10611 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
10612 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
10613 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
10614 </p>
10617 The postrm has to do the reverse:
10618 <example>
10619 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
10620 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10621 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10623 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
10624 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
10625 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
10626 upgrades are no longer supported):
10627 <example>
10628 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10629 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10630 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10632 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
10633 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
10634 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
10635 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
10636 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
10637 the diversion will fail.
10638 </p>
10641 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
10642 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
10643 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
10644 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
10645 does not exist.</p>
10646 </appendix>
10648 </book>
10649 </debiandoc>
10650 <!-- Local variables: -->
10651 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
10652 <!-- End: -->
10653 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->